]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
ld: Initial DT_RELR support
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
a2c58332 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
a2c58332 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
a2c58332 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2022 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 686field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
6f365fda
L
1296@item indirect-extern-access
1297@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1298Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1299.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1300canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1301This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1302@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1303
1304@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1305GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1306section.
1307
cd6d6c15
NC
1308@item initfirst
1309This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1310It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1311before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1312the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1313the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1314objects.
1315
1316@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1318so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1319libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1320
c3805e4c
VDM
1321@item unique
1322@itemx nounique
1323When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1324object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1325and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1326primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1327al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1328of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1329and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1330
279d901e
L
1331@item lam-u48
1332Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1333to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1334
1335@item lam-u57
1336Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1337to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u48-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-u57-report=none
1352@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1355property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1356@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1360make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
1363@item lam-report=none
1364@itemx lam-report=warning
1365@itemx lam-report=error
1366Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1367GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1368section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1369linker not report missing properties in input files.
1370@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1371missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1372the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1373Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1374
5fa222e4
AM
1375@item lazy
1376When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1377dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1378the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1379Lazy binding is the default.
1380
cd6d6c15 1381@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1382Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1383
e6e2dfbd
AM
1384@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1385Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1386
e6e2dfbd
AM
1387@item muldefs
1388Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1389
cd6d6c15 1390@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1391Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1392defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1393
1394@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1395Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1396should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1397
1398@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1399Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1400
1401@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1402Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1403
1404@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1405Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1406
6aa29e7b
JJ
1407@item noexecstack
1408Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1409
e6e2dfbd
AM
1410@item noextern-protected-data
1411Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1412library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1413used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1414generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1415module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1416i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1417
e6e2dfbd
AM
1418@item noreloc-overflow
1419Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1420relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1421overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1422
cd6d6c15
NC
1423@item now
1424When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1425dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1426when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1427function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1428called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1429
1430@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1431Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1432
6a91be86
L
1433@item pack-relative-relocs
1434@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1435Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1436and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1437@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1438building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1439@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
1440relative relocation. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1441
6aa29e7b 1442@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1443@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1444Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1445specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1446relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1447than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1448Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1449
68b00778
L
1450@item report-relative-reloc
1451Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1452Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1453
47acac12
L
1454@item separate-code
1455@itemx noseparate-code
1456Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1457specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1458be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1459code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1460
e6e2dfbd
AM
1461@item shstk
1462Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1463to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1464Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1465
04c3a755 1466@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1467Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1468Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1469@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1470
8ee10e86
AM
1471@item start-stop-gc
1472@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1473@cindex start-stop-gc
1474When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1475section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1476input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1477@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1478@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1479linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1480sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1481were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1482definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1483object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1484linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1485@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1486treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1487
cae64165
RM
1488@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1489@cindex visibility
1490@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1491Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1492@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1493Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1494@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1495start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1496compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1497recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1498programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1499between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1500
e6e2dfbd
AM
1501@item text
1502@itemx notext
1503@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1504Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1505or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1506report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1507
97a232d7
NC
1508@item undefs
1509Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1510either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1511This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1512
2d95647b
L
1513@item unique-symbol
1514@itemx nounique-symbol
1515Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1516".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1517is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1518
b0ab0693 1519@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1520@item x86-64-v2
1521@item x86-64-v3
1522@itemx x86-64-v4
1523Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1524@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1525@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1526@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1527@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1528Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1529
cd6d6c15
NC
1530@end table
1531
ece2d90e 1532Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1533
1534@kindex -(
1535@cindex groups of archives
1536@item -( @var{archives} -)
1537@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1538The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1539either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1540
1541The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1542references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1543the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1544archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1545object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1546would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1547they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1548resolved.
1549
1550Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1551it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1552more archives.
1553
69da35b5
NC
1554@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1555@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1556@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1557@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1558Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1559recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1560and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1561the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1562behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1563so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1564restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1565
4a43e768
AM
1566@kindex --as-needed
1567@kindex --no-as-needed
1568@item --as-needed
1569@itemx --no-as-needed
1570This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1571on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1572the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1573on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1574needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1575emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1576non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1577the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1578non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1579Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1580the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1581needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1582from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1583
6418520e
NC
1584Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1585an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1586@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1587@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1588
e56f61be
L
1589@kindex --add-needed
1590@kindex --no-add-needed
1591@item --add-needed
1592@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1593These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1594their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1595options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1596and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1597
252b5132
RH
1598@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1599@item -assert @var{keyword}
1600This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1601
1602@kindex -Bdynamic
1603@kindex -dy
1604@kindex -call_shared
1605@item -Bdynamic
1606@itemx -dy
1607@itemx -call_shared
1608Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1609for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1610default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1611for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1612multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1613@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1614
a1ab1d2a
UD
1615@kindex -Bgroup
1616@item -Bgroup
1617Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1618section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1619object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1620@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1621only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1622
252b5132
RH
1623@kindex -Bstatic
1624@kindex -dn
1625@kindex -non_shared
1626@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1627@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1628@itemx -dn
1629@itemx -non_shared
1630@itemx -static
1631Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1632platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1633variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1634may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1635library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1636option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1637option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1638shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1639references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1640libraries.
252b5132
RH
1641
1642@kindex -Bsymbolic
1643@item -Bsymbolic
1644When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1645definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1646for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1647within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1648platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1649
40b36307
L
1650@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1651@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1652When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1653symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1654This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1655libraries.
40b36307 1656
cf893b0e
FS
1657@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1658@item -Bno-symbolic
1659This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1660@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1661
55255dae
L
1662@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1663@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1664Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1665typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1666global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1667within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1668to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1669in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1670which support shared libraries.
1671
1672The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1673scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1674
40b36307
L
1675@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1676@item --dynamic-list-data
1677Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1678
1679@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1680@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1681Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1682is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1683
0b8a70d9
L
1684@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1685@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1686Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1687
252b5132
RH
1688@kindex --check-sections
1689@kindex --no-check-sections
1690@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1691@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1692Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1693been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1694perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1695suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1696allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1697restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1698Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1699force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1700option.
252b5132 1701
ddbb8a31
NC
1702@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1703@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1704@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1705@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1706This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1707by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1708command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1709output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1710input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1711specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1712follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1713behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1714
1715This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1716libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1717mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1718their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1719required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1720the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1721dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1722symbols.
1723
252b5132
RH
1724@cindex cross reference table
1725@kindex --cref
1726@item --cref
1727Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1728generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1729Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1730
1731The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1732easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1733sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1734symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1735definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1736where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1737symbol are listed.
252b5132 1738
5dba6f05
NA
1739@cindex ctf variables
1740@kindex --ctf-variables
1741@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1742@item --ctf-variables
1743@item --no-ctf-variables
1744The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1745types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1746table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1747conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1748usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1749@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1750The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1751
1752@cindex ctf type sharing
1753@kindex --ctf-share-types
1754@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1755Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1756
1757@table @samp
1758@item share-unconflicted
1759Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1760where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1761translation unit. This is the default.
1762
1763@item share-duplicated
1764Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1765dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1766dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1767always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1768larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1769large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1770consumer at runtime.
1771@end table
1772
4818e05f
AM
1773@cindex common allocation
1774@kindex --no-define-common
1775@item --no-define-common
1776This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1777The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1778@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1779
1780The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1781the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1782of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1783forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1784Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1785from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1786This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1787and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1788duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1789paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1790
7bdf4127
AB
1791@cindex group allocation in linker script
1792@cindex section groups
1793@cindex COMDAT
1794@kindex --force-group-allocation
1795@item --force-group-allocation
1796This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1797normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1798default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1799change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1800command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1801effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1802
252b5132 1803@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1804@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1805@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1806Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1807address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1808times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1809limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1810context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1811symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1812constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1813using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1814@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1815equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1816
54874444
AB
1817The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1818in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1819symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1820placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1821the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1822consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1823@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1824you are trying to achieve.
1825
252b5132 1826@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1827@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1828@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1829@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1830@itemx --no-demangle
1831These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1832and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1833present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1834underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1835mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1836different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1837to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1838demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1839is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1840
1841@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1842@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1843@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1844@item -I@var{file}
1845@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1846Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1847generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1848linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1849doing.
1850
9b8b325a
RF
1851@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1852@item --no-dynamic-linker
1853When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1854linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1855executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1856entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1857
a70f34c0
NC
1858@kindex --embedded-relocs
1859@item --embedded-relocs
1860This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1861that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1862is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1863targets.
1864
3f0a5f17
ME
1865@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1866@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1867Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1868in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1869
7ce691ae 1870@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1871@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1872@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1873@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1874Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1875with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1876
252b5132
RH
1877@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1878@item --force-exe-suffix
1879Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1880
1881If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1882@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1883the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1884option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1885Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1886it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1887
1888@kindex --gc-sections
1889@kindex --no-gc-sections
1890@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1891@item --gc-sections
1892@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1893Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1894targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1895performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1896@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1897collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1898implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1899
d5465ba2
AM
1900@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1901examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1902symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1903command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1904referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1905libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1906referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1907the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1908relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1909@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1910
ac69cbc6 1911This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1912@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1913specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1914@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1915command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1916
99fabbc9
JL
1917As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1918@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1919
c17d87de
NC
1920@kindex --print-gc-sections
1921@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1922@cindex garbage collection
1923@item --print-gc-sections
1924@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1925List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1926printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1927collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1928default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1929be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1930line.
1931
22185505 1932@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1933@cindex garbage collection
1934@item --gc-keep-exported
1935When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1936collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1937default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1938executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1939collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1940Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1941it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1942ELF format targets.
1943
30824704
RM
1944@kindex --print-output-format
1945@cindex output format
1946@item --print-output-format
1947Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1948other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1949in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1950
3604cb1f
TG
1951@kindex --print-memory-usage
1952@cindex memory usage
1953@item --print-memory-usage
1954Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1955the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1956quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1957headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1958parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1959
1960@smallexample
1961Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1962 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1963 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1964@end smallexample
1965
252b5132
RH
1966@cindex help
1967@cindex usage
1968@kindex --help
1969@item --help
1970Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1971
ea20a7da
CC
1972@kindex --target-help
1973@item --target-help
a094d01f 1974Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1975
2509a395
SL
1976@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1977@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1978Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1979@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1980@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1981
1982Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1983written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1984inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1985file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1986@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1987output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1988@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1989
1990@smallexample
1991 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1992 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1993 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1994 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1995 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1996 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1997 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1998 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1999 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2000 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2001@end smallexample
2002
2003It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2004
2005If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2006operation.
252b5132
RH
2007
2008@cindex memory usage
2009@kindex --no-keep-memory
2010@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2011@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2012symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2013instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2014necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2015while linking a large executable.
2016
2017@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2018@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2019@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2020@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2021@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2022Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2023is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2024The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2025behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2026libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2027
97a232d7
NC
2028The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2029
aa713662
L
2030@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2031@kindex -z muldefs
2032@item --allow-multiple-definition
2033@itemx -z muldefs
2034Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2035report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2036first definition will be used.
2037
b79e8c78 2038@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2039@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2040@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2041@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2042Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2043This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2044determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2045shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2046how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2047
903249d7
NC
2048The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2049referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2050an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2051a shared library.
2052
2053The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2054libraries specified at link time are that:
2055
2056@itemize @bullet
2057@item
2058A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2059that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2060resolvable at load time.
2061@item
2062There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2063symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2064
2065The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2066select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2067architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2068appropriate memset function.
2069@end itemize
b79e8c78 2070
23ae20f5
NC
2071@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2072@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2073If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2074@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2075only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2076libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2077``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2078undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2079will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2080might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2081error message will be displayed.
2082
2083The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2084switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2085
31941635
L
2086@kindex --no-undefined-version
2087@item --no-undefined-version
2088Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2089it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2090will be issued instead.
2091
3e3b46e5
PB
2092@kindex --default-symver
2093@item --default-symver
2094Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2095exported symbols.
2096
2097@kindex --default-imported-symver
2098@item --default-imported-symver
2099Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2100imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2101
252b5132
RH
2102@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2103@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2104Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2105files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2106been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2107This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2108errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2109have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2110inappropriate.
2111
fe7929ce
AM
2112@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2113@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2114Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2115library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2116
252b5132
RH
2117@kindex --no-whole-archive
2118@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2119Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2120archive files.
2121
2122@cindex output file after errors
2123@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2124@item --noinhibit-exec
2125Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2126Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2127errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2128when it issues any error whatsoever.
2129
0a9c1c8e
CD
2130@kindex -nostdlib
2131@item -nostdlib
2132Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2133command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2134(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2135
252b5132 2136@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2137@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2138@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2139@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2140file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2141@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2142object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2143object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2144should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2145usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2146name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2147list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2148command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2149this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2150@end ifclear
2151
76359541
TP
2152@kindex --out-implib
2153@item --out-implib @var{file}
2154Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2155the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2156library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2157may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2158behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2159step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2160the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2161
36af4a4e
JJ
2162@kindex -pie
2163@kindex --pic-executable
2164@item -pie
2165@itemx --pic-executable
2166@cindex position independent executables
2167Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2168ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2169libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2170address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2171normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2172defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2173
e8f6c2a5
FS
2174@kindex -no-pie
2175@item -no-pie
2176@cindex position dependent executables
2177Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2178
252b5132
RH
2179@kindex -qmagic
2180@item -qmagic
2181This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2182
2183@kindex -Qy
2184@item -Qy
2185This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2186
2187@kindex --relax
2188@cindex synthesizing linker
2189@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2190@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2191@item --relax
28d5f677 2192@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2193An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2194@ifset GENERIC
2195This option is only supported on a few targets.
2196@end ifset
2197@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2198@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2199@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2200@ifset XTENSA
2201@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2202@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2203@ifset M68HC11
2204@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2205@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2206@ifset NIOSII
2207@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2208@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2209@ifset POWERPC
2210@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2211@end ifset
252b5132 2212
ccd9fae5 2213On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2214global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2215addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2216synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2217instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2218
2219On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2220debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2221@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2222This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2223family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2224@end ifset
2225
ccd9fae5
NC
2226On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2227@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2228
ccd9fae5
NC
2229On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2230and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2231
252b5132
RH
2232@cindex retaining specified symbols
2233@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2234@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2235@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2236@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2237Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2238discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2239symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2240@ifset GENERIC
2241(such as VxWorks)
2242@end ifset
2243where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2244run-time memory.
2245
2246@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2247or symbols needed for relocations.
2248
2249You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2250line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2251
2252@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2253@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2254@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2255@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2256Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2257linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2258arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2259them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2260
2261The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2262are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2263description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2264in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2265have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2266
2267If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2268contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2269is defined.
252b5132 2270
ff5dcc92 2271The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2272SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2273@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2274runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2275options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2276gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2277file systems.
252b5132 2278
ff5dcc92 2279For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2280followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2281the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2282@end ifset
2283
2284@ifset GENERIC
2285@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2286@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2287@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2288When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2289happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2290of the input files.
2291
2292When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2293non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2294shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2295explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2296specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2297@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2298either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2299appearing multiple times.
2300
e680a6b6
NC
2301The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2302directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2303containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2304and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
230564-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2306
2307The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2308@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2309supported.
2310
28c309a2
NC
2311This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2312that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2313is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2314runtime linker would do.
2315
252b5132 2316The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2317libraries:
d8e4137b 2318
252b5132
RH
2319@enumerate
2320@item
ff5dcc92 2321Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2322@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2323Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2324between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2325specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2326used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2327at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2328by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2329the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2330@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2331On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2332@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2333environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2334@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2335On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2336directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2337@item
a1b8d843 2338For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2339variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2340@item
ec4eb78a
L
2341For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2342@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2343libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2344@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2345@item
d8e4137b
NC
2346For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2347exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2348to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2349defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2350configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2351@item
2352For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2353the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2354header file.
2355@item
364d7729
AM
2356Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2357linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2358by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2359@item
2360The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2361@item
2362Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2363@item
2364Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2365linker script.
252b5132
RH
2366@end enumerate
2367
6418520e
NC
2368Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2369the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2370is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2371library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2372@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2373directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2374this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2375@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2376of the first.
2377
252b5132
RH
2378If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2379warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2380
252b5132
RH
2381@end ifset
2382
2383@kindex -shared
2384@kindex -Bshareable
2385@item -shared
2386@itemx -Bshareable
2387@cindex shared libraries
2388Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2389and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2390shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2391undefined symbols in the link.
2392
252b5132 2393@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2394@item --sort-common
2395@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2396@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2397This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2398ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2399sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2400eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2401between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2402specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2403
2509a395
SL
2404@kindex --sort-section=name
2405@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2406This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2407patterns in the linker script.
2408
2509a395
SL
2409@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2410@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2411This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2412patterns in the linker script.
2413
a70f34c0
NC
2414@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2415@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2416This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2417.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2418post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2419
252b5132 2420@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2421@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2422Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2423each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2424size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2425
2426@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2427@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2428Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2429output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2430This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2431certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2432cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2433that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2434support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2435input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2436more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2437many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2438
2439@kindex --stats
2440@item --stats
2441Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2442as execution time and memory usage.
2443
2509a395 2444@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2445@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2446Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2447configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2448that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2449
a70f34c0
NC
2450@kindex --task-link
2451@item --task-link
2452This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2453file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2454
252b5132
RH
2455@kindex --traditional-format
2456@cindex traditional format
2457@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2458For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2459the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2460use the traditional format instead.
2461
2462@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2463For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2464symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2465full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2466@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2467trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2468combine duplicate entries.
2469
2509a395
SL
2470@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2471@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2472Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2473address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2474times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2475line.
2476@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2477for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2478@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2479should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2480sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2481
2509a395
SL
2482@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2483@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2484@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2485@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2486@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2487@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2488@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2489Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2490@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2491
2509a395
SL
2492@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2493@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2494@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2495When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2496byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2497
9d5777a3
RM
2498@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2499@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2500@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2501When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2502the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2503text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2504
0d705e9f
AM
2505@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2506@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2507@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2508When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2509model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2510
560e09e9
NC
2511@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2512@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2513Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2514values for @samp{method}:
2515
2516@table @samp
2517@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2518Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2519
2520@item report-all
da8bce14 2521Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2522
2523@item ignore-in-object-files
2524Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2525ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2526
2527@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2528Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2529ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2530when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2531libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2532command line.
2533@end table
2534
2535The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2536by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2537
2538Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2539unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2540can change this to a warning.
2541
1715a13c
L
2542@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2543@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2544@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2545@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2546Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2547supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2548the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2549argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2550
2551@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2552@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2553@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2554Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2555used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2556about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2557is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2558see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2559use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2560symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2561@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2562
7ce691ae 2563@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2564@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2565@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2566@item --warn-common
2567Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2568a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2569but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2570you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2571Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2572warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2573
2574There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2575
2576@table @samp
2577@item int i = 1;
2578A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2579file.
2580
2581@item extern int i;
2582An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2583There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2584variable somewhere.
2585
2586@item int i;
2587A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2588variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2589The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2590single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2591size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2592a definition of the same variable.
2593@end table
2594
2595The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2596Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2597just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2598encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2599a common symbol.
2600
2601@enumerate
2602@item
2603Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2604definition for the symbol.
2605@smallexample
2606@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2607 overridden by definition
2608@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2609@end smallexample
2610
2611@item
2612Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2613the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2614except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2615@smallexample
2616@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2617 overriding common
2618@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2619@end smallexample
2620
2621@item
2622Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2623@smallexample
2624@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2625 of `@var{symbol}'
2626@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2627@end smallexample
2628
2629@item
2630Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2631@smallexample
2632@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2633 overridden by larger common
2634@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2635@end smallexample
2636
2637@item
2638Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2639the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2640encountered in a different order.
2641@smallexample
2642@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2643 overriding smaller common
2644@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2645@end smallexample
2646@end enumerate
2647
2648@kindex --warn-constructors
2649@item --warn-constructors
2650Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2651object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2652detect the use of global constructors.
2653
2654@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2655@item --warn-multiple-gp
2656Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2657This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2658Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2659section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2660of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2661base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2662base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2663bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2664large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2665values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2666option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2667
2668@kindex --warn-once
2669@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2670@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2671@item --warn-once
2672Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2673which refers to it.
2674
2675@kindex --warn-section-align
2676@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2677@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2678@item --warn-section-align
2679Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2680alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2681The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2682is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2683the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2684
a6dbf402
L
2685@kindex --warn-textrel
2686@item --warn-textrel
2687Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2688or shared object.
8fdd7217 2689
a0c402a5
L
2690@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2691@item --warn-alternate-em
2692Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2693
560e09e9
NC
2694@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2695@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2696If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2697@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2698This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2699
2700@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2701@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2702This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2703it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2704
252b5132
RH
2705@kindex --whole-archive
2706@cindex including an entire archive
2707@item --whole-archive
2708For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2709@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2710in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2711files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2712library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2713library. This option may be used more than once.
2714
7ec229ce 2715Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2716about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2717Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2718list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2719your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2720
2509a395
SL
2721@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2722@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2723Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2724@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2725undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2726@var{symbol}.
2727
2728This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2729wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2730wishes to call the system function, it should call
2731@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2732
2733Here is a trivial example:
2734
2735@smallexample
2736void *
cc2f008e 2737__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2738@{
cc2f008e 2739 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2740 return __real_malloc (c);
2741@}
2742@end smallexample
2743
ff5dcc92 2744If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2745all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2746instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2747call the real @code{malloc} function.
2748
2749You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2750links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2751you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2752file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2753call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2754
4ea904ed
SH
2755Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2756internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2757@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2758@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2759
2760@smallexample
2761int
2762f (void)
2763@{
2764 return 123;
2765@}
2766
2767int
2768g (void)
2769@{
2770 return f();
2771@}
2772@end smallexample
2773
6aa29e7b 2774@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2775@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2776@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2777@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2778Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2779(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2780section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2781
e41b3a13
JJ
2782@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2783@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2784Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2785generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2786if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2787
6c1439be
L
2788@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2789@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2790@item --enable-new-dtags
2791@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2792This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2793systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2794@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2795and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2796If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2797created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2798those options are only available for ELF systems.
2799
2d643429 2800@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2801@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2802Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2803close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2804time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2805increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2806value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2807
fdc90cb4
JJ
2808@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2809@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2810Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2811@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2812new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2813the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2814hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2815but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2816
0ce398f1
L
2817@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2818@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2819@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2820@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2821@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2822@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2823@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2824@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2825On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2826compressed using zlib.
2827
2828@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2829sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2830DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2831instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2832also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2833sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2834
2835The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2836@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2837
2838Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2839sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2840for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2841uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2842
2843The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2844involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2845default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2846@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2847
35835446
JR
2848@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2849@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2850This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2851linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2852for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2853about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2854
4f9c04f7 2855Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28561021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2857run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2858has been used.
2859
2860The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2861enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2862
a8dde0a2
L
2863@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2864@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
2865@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
2866of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
2867maximum cache size to @var{size}.
2868
c0065db7
RM
2869@kindex --build-id
2870@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2871@item --build-id
2872@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2873Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2874or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2875unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2876@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2877@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2878@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2879the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2880string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2881@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2882is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2883
2884The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2885that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2886unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2887to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2888file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2889string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2890
2891Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2892@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2893@end table
2894
0285c67d
NC
2895@c man end
2896
36f63dca 2897@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2898
0285c67d
NC
2899@c man begin OPTIONS
2900
ff5dcc92 2901The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2902the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2903normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2904use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2905@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2906like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2907symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2908object file).
2909
2910In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2911support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2912PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2913values by either a space or an equals sign.
2914
ff5dcc92 2915@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2916
2917@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2918@item --add-stdcall-alias
2919If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2920as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2921[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2922
2923@kindex --base-file
2924@item --base-file @var{file}
2925Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2926addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2927@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2928[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2929
2930@kindex --dll
2931@item --dll
2932Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2933@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2934file.
bb10df36 2935[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2936
88183869
DK
2937@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2938@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2939@item --enable-long-section-names
2940@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2941The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2942the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2943for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2944fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2945to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2946allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2947disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2948generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2949as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2950with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2951GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2952information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2953option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2954section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2955when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2956image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2957[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2958
252b5132
RH
2959@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2960@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2961@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2962@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2963If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2964do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2965only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2966resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2967undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2968@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2969to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2970warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2971import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2972to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2973feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2974@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2975mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2976[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2977
522f09cd
KT
2978@kindex --leading-underscore
2979@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2980@item --leading-underscore
2981@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2982For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2983in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2984disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2985
252b5132
RH
2986@cindex DLLs, creating
2987@kindex --export-all-symbols
2988@item --export-all-symbols
2989If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2990be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2991otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2992explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2993attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2994option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2995@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2996@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2997exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2998re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2999such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3000@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3001@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3002Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3003not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3004extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3005(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3006These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3007@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3008@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3009@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3010@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3011[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3012
3013@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3014@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3015Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3016exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3017[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3018
2927aaca
NC
3019@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3020@item --exclude-all-symbols
3021Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3022[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3023
252b5132
RH
3024@kindex --file-alignment
3025@item --file-alignment
3026Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3027file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3028512.
bb10df36 3029[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3030
3031@cindex heap size
3032@kindex --heap
3033@item --heap @var{reserve}
3034@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3035Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3036to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3037committed.
bb10df36 3038[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3039
3040@cindex image base
3041@kindex --image-base
3042@item --image-base @var{value}
3043Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3044the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3045is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3046your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3047other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3048for dlls.
bb10df36 3049[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3050
3051@kindex --kill-at
3052@item --kill-at
3053If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3054symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3055[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3056
26d2d8a2
BF
3057@kindex --large-address-aware
3058@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3059If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3060header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3061greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3062or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3063section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3064[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3065
f69a2f97
NC
3066@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3067@item --disable-large-address-aware
3068Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3069This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3070driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3071addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3072[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3073
252b5132
RH
3074@kindex --major-image-version
3075@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3076Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3077[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3078
3079@kindex --major-os-version
3080@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3081Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3082[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3083
3084@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3085@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3086Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3087[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3088
3089@kindex --minor-image-version
3090@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3091Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3092[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3093
3094@kindex --minor-os-version
3095@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3096Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3097[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3098
3099@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3100@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3101Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3102[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3103
3104@cindex DEF files, creating
3105@cindex DLLs, creating
3106@kindex --output-def
3107@item --output-def @var{file}
3108The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3109file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3110(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3111library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3112automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3113[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3114
b044cda1 3115@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3116@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3117@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3118@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3119Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3120@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3121By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3122for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3123execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3124[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3125
3126@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3127@item --disable-auto-image-base
3128Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3129user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3130default.
bb10df36 3131[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3132
3133@cindex DLLs, linking to
3134@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3135@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3136When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3137search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3138@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3139between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3140uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3141@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3142[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3143
3144@kindex --enable-auto-import
3145@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3146Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3147DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3148mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3149[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3150
3151The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3152feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3153
3154Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3155of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3156PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3157
e2a83dd0
NC
3158Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3159data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3160placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3161around a problem with consts that is described here:
3162http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3163
4d8907ac
DS
3164Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3165see this message:
0d888aac 3166
ece2d90e 3167"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3168documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3169
ece2d90e
NC
3170This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3171ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3172allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3173fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3174constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3175multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3176this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3177of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3178the warning, and exit.
3179
3180There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3181data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3182
2fa9fc65
NC
3183One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3184of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3185this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3186
c0065db7
RM
3187A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3188that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3189there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3190a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3191
3192@example
3193extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3194extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3195 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3196@end example
3197
3198or
3199
3200@example
3201extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3202extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3203 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3204@end example
3205
c0065db7 3206For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3207is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3208
3209@example
3210extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3211extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3212 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3213@end example
3214
c406afaf
NC
3215or
3216
3217@example
3218extern long long extern_ll;
3219extern_ll -->
3220 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3221@end example
3222
2fa9fc65 3223A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3224'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3225@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3226requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3227building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3228merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3229between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3230constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3231
3232Original:
3233@example
3234--foo.h
3235extern int arr[];
3236--foo.c
3237#include "foo.h"
3238void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3239 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3240@}
3241@end example
3242
3243Solution 1:
3244@example
3245--foo.h
3246extern int arr[];
3247--foo.c
3248#include "foo.h"
3249void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3250 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3251 volatile int *parr = arr;
3252 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3253@}
3254@end example
3255
3256Solution 2:
3257@example
3258--foo.h
3259/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3260#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3261 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3262#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3263#else
3264#define FOO_IMPORT
3265#endif
3266extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3267--foo.c
3268#include "foo.h"
3269void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3270 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3271@}
3272@end example
3273
c0065db7 3274A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3275library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3276for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3277functions).
b044cda1
CW
3278
3279@kindex --disable-auto-import
3280@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3281Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3282@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3283[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3284
2fa9fc65
NC
3285@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3286@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3287If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3288that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3289a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3290environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3291[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3292
3293@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3294@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3295Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3296[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3297
b044cda1
CW
3298@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3299@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3300Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3301[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3302
252b5132
RH
3303@kindex --section-alignment
3304@item --section-alignment
3305Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3306addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3307[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3308
3309@cindex stack size
3310@kindex --stack
3311@item --stack @var{reserve}
3312@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3313Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3314to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3315committed.
bb10df36 3316[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3317
3318@kindex --subsystem
3319@item --subsystem @var{which}
3320@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3321@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3322Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3323legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3324@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3325the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3326@var{which}.
bb10df36 3327[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3328
2f563b51
DK
3329The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3330of the PE file header:
3331[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3332
2d5c3743
NC
3333@kindex --high-entropy-va
3334@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3335@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3336Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3337(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3338
dc9bd8c9
HD
3339This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3340@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3341
2f563b51
DK
3342@kindex --dynamicbase
3343@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3344@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3345The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3346randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3347Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3348can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3349This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3350
3351@kindex --forceinteg
3352@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3353@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3354Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3355default.
2f563b51
DK
3356
3357@kindex --nxcompat
3358@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3359@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3360The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3361This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3362targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3363
3364@kindex --no-isolation
3365@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3366@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3367Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3368This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3369
3370@kindex --no-seh
3371@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3372@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3373The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3374this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3375
3376@kindex --no-bind
3377@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3378@itemx --disable-no-bind
3379Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3380
3381@kindex --wdmdriver
3382@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3383@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3384The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3385by default.
9d5777a3 3386
2f563b51
DK
3387@kindex --tsaware
3388@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3389@itemx --disable-tsaware
3390The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3391default.
2f563b51 3392
0cb112f7
CF
3393@kindex --insert-timestamp
3394@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3395@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3396Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3397as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3398other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3399will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3400same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3401can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3402that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3403identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3404
3405@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3406@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3407@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3408Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3409is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3410This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3411@end table
3412
0285c67d
NC
3413@c man end
3414
ac145307
BS
3415@ifset C6X
3416@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3417
3418@c man begin OPTIONS
3419
3420The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3421libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3422all executables use an index of 0.
3423
3424@table @gcctabopt
3425
3426@kindex --dsbt-size
3427@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3428This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3429or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3430entries.
3431
3432@kindex --dsbt-index
3433@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3434This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3435to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3436executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3437@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3438
fbd9ad90
PB
3439@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3440The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3441exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3442
ac145307
BS
3443@end table
3444
3445@c man end
3446@end ifset
3447
b8891f8d
AJ
3448@ifset CSKY
3449@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3450
3451@c man begin OPTIONS
3452
3453@table @gcctabopt
3454
3455@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3456@item --branch-stub
3457This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3458sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3459usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3460can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3461the compiler or assembler.
3462
3463@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3464@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3465This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3466It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3467be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3468stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3469sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3470@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3471linker should choose suitable defaults.
3472
3473@end table
3474
3475@c man end
3476@end ifset
3477
93fd0973
SC
3478@ifset M68HC11
3479@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3480
3481@c man begin OPTIONS
3482
3483The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3484memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3485
3486@table @gcctabopt
3487
3488@kindex --no-trampoline
3489@item --no-trampoline
3490This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3491is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3492instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3493
3494@kindex --bank-window
3495@item --bank-window @var{name}
3496This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3497the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3498The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3499paging and addresses within the memory window.
3500
3501@end table
3502
3503@c man end
3504@end ifset
3505
7fb9f789
NC
3506@ifset M68K
3507@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3508
3509@c man begin OPTIONS
3510
3511The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3512when linking for 68K targets.
3513
3514@table @gcctabopt
3515
3516@kindex --got
3517@item --got=@var{type}
3518This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3519@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3520@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3521Info entry for @file{ld}.
3522
3523@end table
3524
3525@c man end
3526@end ifset
3527
833794fc
MR
3528@ifset MIPS
3529@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3530
3531@c man begin OPTIONS
3532
3533The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3534generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3535linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3536
3537@table @gcctabopt
3538
3539@kindex --insn32
3540@item --insn32
3541@kindex --no-insn32
3542@itemx --no-insn32
3543These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3544generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3545or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
354632-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3547used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3548possible.
3549
8b10b0b3
MR
3550@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3551@item --ignore-branch-isa
3552@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3553@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3554These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3555transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3556accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3557is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3558instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3559equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3560calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3561a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3562an error.
3563
3734320d
MF
3564@kindex --compact-branches
3565@item --compact-branches
3566@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3567@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3568These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3569in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3570
833794fc
MR
3571@end table
3572
3573@c man end
3574@end ifset
3575
fa1477dc
SC
3576
3577@ifset PDP11
3578@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3579
3580@c man begin OPTIONS
3581
3582For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3583produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3584for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3585targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3586defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3587here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3588
3589@table @gcctabopt
3590
3591@kindex -N
3592@item -N
3593@kindex --omagic
3594@itemx --omagic
3595
3596Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3597indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3598shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3599writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3600the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3601programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3602from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3603
3604@kindex -n
3605@item -n
3606@kindex --nmagic
3607@itemx --nmagic
3608
3609Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3610indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3611be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3612file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3613byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3614a @emph{pure executable} format.
3615
3616@kindex -z
3617@item -z
3618@kindex --imagic
3619@itemx --imagic
3620
3621Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3622indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3623data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3624instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3625larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3626to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3627shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3628option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3629and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3630this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3631executable} format.
3632
3633@kindex --no-omagic
3634@item --no-omagic
3635
3636Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3637
3638@end table
3639
3640@c man end
3641@end ifset
3642
252b5132
RH
3643@ifset UsesEnvVars
3644@node Environment
3645@section Environment Variables
3646
0285c67d
NC
3647@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3648
560e09e9 3649You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3650@ifclear SingleFormat
3651@code{GNUTARGET},
3652@end ifclear
3653@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3654
36f63dca 3655@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3656@kindex GNUTARGET
3657@cindex default input format
3658@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3659use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3660of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3661@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3662of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3663attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3664this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3665there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3666object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3667BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3668in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3669@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3670
3671@kindex LDEMULATION
3672@cindex default emulation
3673@cindex emulation, default
3674@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3675@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3676behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3677available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3678the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3679variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3680linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3681
3682@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3683@cindex demangling, default
3684Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3685@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3686default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3687a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3688may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3689options.
3690
0285c67d
NC
3691@c man end
3692@end ifset
3693
252b5132
RH
3694@node Scripts
3695@chapter Linker Scripts
3696
3697@cindex scripts
3698@cindex linker scripts
3699@cindex command files
3700Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3701written in the linker command language.
3702
3703The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3704the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3705the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3706more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3707direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3708described below.
3709
3710The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3711yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3712linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3713to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3714such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3715
3716You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3717line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3718default linker script.
3719
3720You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3721to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3722Linker Scripts}.
3723
3724@menu
3725* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3726* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3727* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3728* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3729* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3730* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3731* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3732* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3733* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3734* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3735* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3736@end menu
3737
3738@node Basic Script Concepts
3739@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3740@cindex linker script concepts
3741We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3742describe the linker script language.
3743
3744The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3745file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3746@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3747The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3748purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3749among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3750section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3751in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3752
3753Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3754also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3755contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3756the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3757A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3758area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3759loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3760which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3761of debugging information.
3762
3763Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3764first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3765the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3766@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3767section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3768same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3769is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3770(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3771based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3772RAM address would be the VMA.
3773
3774You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3775program with the @samp{-h} option.
3776
3777Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3778@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3779has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3780information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3781will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3782static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3783referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3784
3785You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3786program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3787option.
3788
3789@node Script Format
3790@section Linker Script Format
3791@cindex linker script format
3792Linker scripts are text files.
3793
3794You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3795either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3796symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3797generally ignored.
3798
3799Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3800If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3801otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3802double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3803file name.
3804
3805You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3806@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3807to whitespace.
3808
3809@node Simple Example
3810@section Simple Linker Script Example
3811@cindex linker script example
3812@cindex example of linker script
3813Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3814
3815The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3816@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3817memory layout of the output file.
3818
3819The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3820describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3821code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3822@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3823Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3824your input files.
3825
3826For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
38270x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3828linker script which will do that:
3829@smallexample
3830SECTIONS
3831@{
3832 . = 0x10000;
3833 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3834 . = 0x8000000;
3835 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3836 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3837@}
3838@end smallexample
3839
3840You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3841followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3842descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3843
252b5132
RH
3844The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3845sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3846counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3847other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3848current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3849incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3850@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3851
3852The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3853required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3854after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3855which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3856wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3857means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3858
3859Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3860@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3861@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3862
3863The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3864the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3865at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3866output section, the value of the location counter will be
3867@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3868effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3869immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3870
3871The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3872alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3873example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3874sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3875may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3876sections.
3877
3878That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3879
3880@node Simple Commands
3881@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3882@cindex linker script simple commands
3883In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3884
3885@menu
3886* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3887* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3888@ifclear SingleFormat
3889* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3890@end ifclear
3891
4a93e180 3892* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3893* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3894@end menu
3895
3896@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3897@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3898@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3899@cindex start of execution
3900@cindex first instruction
3901@cindex entry point
3902The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3903point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3904entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3905@smallexample
3906ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3907@end smallexample
3908
3909There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3910entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3911stopping when one of them succeeds:
3912@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3913@item
252b5132 3914the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3915@item
252b5132 3916the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3917@item
a094d01f 3918the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3919targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3920check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3921@item
5226a6a8
NC
3922the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
3923executable is being created - the code section is usually
3924@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 3925@item
252b5132
RH
3926The address @code{0}.
3927@end itemize
3928
3929@node File Commands
36f63dca 3930@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3931@cindex linker script file commands
3932Several linker script commands deal with files.
3933
3934@table @code
3935@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3936@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3937@cindex including a linker script
3938Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3939be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3940with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
394110 levels deep.
3942
4006703d
NS
3943You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3944@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3945
252b5132
RH
3946@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3947@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3948@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3949@cindex input files in linker scripts
3950@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3951@cindex linker script input object files
3952The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3953in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3954
3955For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3956a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3957then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3958
3959In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3960script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3961
e3f2db7f
AO
3962In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3963with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3964located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3965for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3966@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3967filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3968@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3969
3970If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3971the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3972found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3973not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3974path.
252b5132 3975
ff5dcc92 3976If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3977name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3978@samp{-l}.
3979
3980When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3981files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3982script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3983
3984@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3985@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3986@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3987@cindex grouping input files
3988The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3989files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3990new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3991in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3992
b717d30e
JJ
3993@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3994@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3995@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3996This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3997commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3998as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3999with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4000when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4001@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4002and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4003setting afterwards.
4004
252b5132
RH
4005@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4006@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4007@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4008The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4009@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4010@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4011Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4012precedence.
4013
4014You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4015output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4016
4017@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4018@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4019@cindex library search path in linker script
4020@cindex archive search path in linker script
4021@cindex search path in linker script
4022The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4023@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4024@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4025on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4026are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4027the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4028
4029@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4030@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4031@cindex first input file
4032The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4033that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4034though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4035when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4036first file.
4037@end table
4038
4039@ifclear SingleFormat
4040@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4041@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4042A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4043
4044@table @code
4045@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4046@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4047@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4048@cindex output file format in linker script
4049The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4050output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4051exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4052(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4053line option takes precedence.
4054
4055You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4056formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4057This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4058desired endianness.
4059
4060If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4061will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4062output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4063used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4064
4065For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4066command:
4067@smallexample
4068OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4069@end smallexample
4070This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4071@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4072option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4073format.
4074
4075@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4076@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4077@cindex input file format in linker script
4078The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4079files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4080This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4081(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4082is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4083command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4084@end table
4085@end ifclear
4086
4a93e180
NC
4087@node REGION_ALIAS
4088@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4089@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4090@cindex region alias
4091@cindex region names
4092
4093Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4094@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4095
4096@smallexample
4097REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4098@end smallexample
4099
4100The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4101memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4102to memory regions. An example follows.
4103
4104Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4105memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4106that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4107non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4108access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4109read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4110sections:
4111
4112@itemize @bullet
4113@item
4114@code{.text} program code;
4115@item
4116@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4117@item
4118@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4119@item
4120@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4121@end itemize
4122
4123The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4124part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4125output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4126systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4127@code{C}:
4128@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4129@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4130@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4131@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4132@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4133@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4134@end multitable
4135The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4136loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4137the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4138the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4139
4140The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4141includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4142memory layout:
4143@smallexample
4144INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4145
4146SECTIONS
4147 @{
4148 .text :
4149 @{
4150 *(.text)
4151 @} > REGION_TEXT
4152 .rodata :
4153 @{
4154 *(.rodata)
4155 rodata_end = .;
4156 @} > REGION_RODATA
4157 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4158 @{
4159 data_start = .;
4160 *(.data)
4161 @} > REGION_DATA
4162 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4163 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4164 .bss :
4165 @{
4166 *(.bss)
4167 @} > REGION_BSS
4168 @}
4169@end smallexample
4170
4171Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4172regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4173variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4174@table @code
4175@item A
4176Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4177@smallexample
4178MEMORY
4179 @{
4180 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4181 @}
4182
4183REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4184REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4185REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4186REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4187@end smallexample
4188@item B
4189Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4190into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4191@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4192@smallexample
4193MEMORY
4194 @{
4195 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4196 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4197 @}
4198
4199REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4200REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4201REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4202REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4203@end smallexample
4204@item C
4205Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4206@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4207initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4208system start into the @code{RAM}.
4209@smallexample
4210MEMORY
4211 @{
4212 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4213 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4214 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4215 @}
4216
4217REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4218REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4219REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4220REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4221@end smallexample
4222@end table
4223
4224It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4225@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4226necessary:
4227@smallexample
4228#include <string.h>
4229
4230extern char data_start [];
4231extern char data_size [];
4232extern char data_load_start [];
4233
4234void copy_data(void)
4235@{
4236 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4237 @{
4238 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4239 @}
4240@}
4241@end smallexample
4242
252b5132 4243@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4244@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4245There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4246
4247@table @code
4248@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4249@kindex ASSERT
4250@cindex assertion in linker script
4251Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4252with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4253
fd1c4238
NC
4254Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4255take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4256inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4257for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4258symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4259
4260@smallexample
4261 .stack :
4262 @{
4263 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4264 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4265 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4266 @}
4267@end smallexample
4268
4269will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4270PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4271can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4272
4273@smallexample
4274 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4275 .stack :
4276 @{
4277 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4278 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4279 @}
4280@end smallexample
4281
4282will work.
4283
252b5132
RH
4284@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4285@kindex EXTERN
4286@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4287Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4288symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4289modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4290each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4291command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4292
4293@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4294@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4295@cindex common allocation in linker script
4296This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4297to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4298output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4299
4818e05f
AM
4300@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4301@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4302@cindex common allocation in linker script
4303This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4304command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4305to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4306
7bdf4127
AB
4307@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4308@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4309@cindex group allocation in linker script
4310@cindex section groups
4311@cindex COMDAT
4312This command has the same effect as the
4313@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4314@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4315and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4316specified (@samp{-r}).
4317
53d25da6
AM
4318@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4319@kindex INSERT
4320@cindex insert user script into default script
4321This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4322augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4323inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4324@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4325default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4326sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4327linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4328insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4329linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4330default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4331of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4332to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4333is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4334
4335@smallexample
4336SECTIONS
4337@{
4338 OVERLAY :
4339 @{
4340 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4341 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4342 @}
4343@}
4344INSERT AFTER .text;
4345@end smallexample
4346
252b5132
RH
4347@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4348@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4349@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4350This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4351references among certain output sections.
4352
4353In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4354using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4355will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4356errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4357a function defined in the other section.
4358
4359The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4360@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4361an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4362@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4363names.
4364
cdf96953
MF
4365@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4366@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4367@cindex cross references
4368This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4369references to one section from a list of other sections.
4370
4371The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4372output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4373a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4374there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4375must never call back.
4376
4377The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4378The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4379If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4380the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4381status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4382names, not input section names.
4383
252b5132
RH
4384@ifclear SingleFormat
4385@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4386@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4387@cindex machine architecture
4388@cindex architecture
4389Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4390of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4391architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4392the @samp{-f} option.
4393@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4394
4395@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4396@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4397This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4398@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4399in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4400@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4401@end table
4402
4403@node Assignments
4404@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4405@cindex assignment in scripts
4406@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4407@cindex variables, defining
4408You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4409the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4410
4411@menu
4412* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4413* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4414* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4415* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4416* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4417@end menu
4418
4419@node Simple Assignments
4420@subsection Simple Assignments
4421
4422You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4423
4424@table @code
4425@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4426@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4427@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4428@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4429@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4430@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4431@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4432@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4433@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4434@end table
4435
4436The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4437@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4438defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4439
4440The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4441may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4442
4443The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4444
4445Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4446
4447You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4448statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4449section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4450
4451The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4452expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4453
4454Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4455assignments may be used:
4456
4457@smallexample
4458floating_point = 0;
4459SECTIONS
4460@{
4461 .text :
4462 @{
4463 *(.text)
4464 _etext = .;
4465 @}
156e34dd 4466 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4467 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4468@}
4469@end smallexample
4470@noindent
4471In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4472zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4473the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4474defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4475upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4476
eb8476a6
MR
4477@node HIDDEN
4478@subsection HIDDEN
4479@cindex HIDDEN
4480For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4481exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4482
4483Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4484@code{HIDDEN}:
4485
4486@smallexample
4487HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4488SECTIONS
4489@{
4490 .text :
4491 @{
4492 *(.text)
4493 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4494 @}
4495 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4496 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4497@}
4498@end smallexample
4499@noindent
4500In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4501
252b5132
RH
4502@node PROVIDE
4503@subsection PROVIDE
4504@cindex PROVIDE
4505In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4506only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4507the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4508@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4509@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4510@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4511@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4512@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4513
4514Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4515@smallexample
4516SECTIONS
4517@{
4518 .text :
4519 @{
4520 *(.text)
4521 _etext = .;
4522 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4523 @}
4524@}
4525@end smallexample
4526
4527In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4528underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4529on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4530underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4531If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4532linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4533
b0daac83
NC
4534Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4535defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4536that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4537when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4538@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4539
7af8e998
L
4540@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4541@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4542@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4543Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4544hidden and won't be exported.
4545
73ae6183
NC
4546@node Source Code Reference
4547@subsection Source Code Reference
4548
4549Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4550intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4551a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4552symbol that does not have a value.
4553
4554Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4555transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4556stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4557prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4558mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4559of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4560variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4561linker script variable might be referred to as:
4562
4563@smallexample
4564 extern int foo;
4565@end smallexample
4566
4567But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4568
4569@smallexample
4570 _foo = 1000;
4571@end smallexample
4572
4573In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4574transformation has taken place.
4575
4576When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4577things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4578in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4579second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4580table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4581contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4582value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4583
4584@smallexample
4585 int foo = 1000;
4586@end smallexample
4587
10bf6894 4588creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4589holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4590number 1000 is initially stored.
4591
4592When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4593first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4594memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4595So:
4596
4597@smallexample
4598 foo = 1;
4599@end smallexample
4600
4601looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4602associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4603address. Whereas:
4604
4605@smallexample
4606 int * a = & foo;
4607@end smallexample
4608
10bf6894 4609looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4610and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4611the variable @samp{a}.
4612
4613Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4614the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4615an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4616
4617@smallexample
4618 foo = 1000;
4619@end smallexample
4620
4621creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4622the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4623address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4624linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4625access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4626
4627Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4628you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4629use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4630section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4631linker script contains these declarations:
4632
4633@smallexample
4634@group
4635 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4636 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4637 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4638@end group
4639@end smallexample
4640
4641Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4642
4643@smallexample
4644@group
4645 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4646
73ae6183
NC
4647 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4648@end group
4649@end smallexample
4650
4651Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4652Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4653arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4654
4655@smallexample
4656@group
4657 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4658
4659 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4660@end group
4661@end smallexample
4662
4663Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4664operators.
73ae6183 4665
252b5132 4666@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4667@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4668@kindex SECTIONS
4669The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4670into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4671
4672The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4673@smallexample
4674SECTIONS
4675@{
4676 @var{sections-command}
4677 @var{sections-command}
4678 @dots{}
4679@}
4680@end smallexample
4681
4682Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4683
4684@itemize @bullet
4685@item
4686an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4687@item
4688a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4689@item
4690an output section description
4691@item
4692an overlay description
4693@end itemize
4694
4695The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4696@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4697those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4698understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4699the layout of the output file.
4700
4701Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4702below.
4703
4704If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4705linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4706section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4707input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4708example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4709in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4710
4711@menu
4712* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4713* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4714* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4715* Input Section:: Input section description
4716* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4717* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4718* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4719* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4720* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4721@end menu
4722
4723@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4724@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4725The full description of an output section looks like this:
4726@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4727@group
7e7d5768 4728@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4729 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4730 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4731 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4732 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4733 @{
4734 @var{output-section-command}
4735 @var{output-section-command}
4736 @dots{}
abc9061b 4737 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4738@end group
4739@end smallexample
4740
4741Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4742
4743The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4744name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4745The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4746the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4747The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4748
4749Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4750
4751@itemize @bullet
4752@item
4753a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4754@item
4755an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4756@item
4757data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4758@item
4759a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4760@end itemize
4761
4762@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4763@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4764@cindex name, section
4765@cindex section name
4766The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4767meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4768support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4769must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4770example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4771output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4772names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4773quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4774characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4775commas must be quoted.
4776
4777The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4778Discarding}.
4779
4780@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4781@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4782@cindex address, section
4783@cindex section address
4784The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4785address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4786is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4787
4788If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4789section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4790to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4791alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4792contained within the output section.
4793
4794The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4795
4796@itemize @bullet
4797@item
4798If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4799is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4800in that region.
4801
4802@item
4803If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4804regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4805section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4806be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4807
4808@item
4809If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4810the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4811counter.
4812@end itemize
4813
4814@noindent
4815For example:
4816
252b5132
RH
4817@smallexample
4818.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4819@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4820
252b5132
RH
4821@noindent
4822and
ea5cae92 4823
252b5132
RH
4824@smallexample
4825.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4826@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4827
252b5132
RH
4828@noindent
4829are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4830@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4831counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4832counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4833input sections.
252b5132
RH
4834
4835The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4836For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4837so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4838do something like this:
4839@smallexample
4840.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4841@end smallexample
4842@noindent
4843This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4844aligned upward to the specified value.
4845
4846Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4847location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4848sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4849
4850@node Input Section
36f63dca 4851@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4852@cindex input sections
4853@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4854The most common output section command is an input section description.
4855
4856The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4857You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4858in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4859map the input files into your memory layout.
4860
4861@menu
4862* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4863* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4864* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4865* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4866* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4867@end menu
4868
4869@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4870@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4871@cindex input section basics
4872An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4873by a list of section names in parentheses.
4874
4875The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4876describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4877
4878The most common input section description is to include all input
4879sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4880include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4881@smallexample
4882*(.text)
4883@end smallexample
4884@noindent
18625d54 4885Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4886@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4887of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4888match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4889example:
252b5132 4890@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4891EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4892@end smallexample
4893@noindent
4894will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4895and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4896placed inside the section list, for example:
4897@smallexample
b4346c09 4898*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4899@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4900@noindent
4901The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4902two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4903more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4904
4905There are two ways to include more than one section:
4906@smallexample
4907*(.text .rdata)
4908*(.text) *(.rdata)
4909@end smallexample
4910@noindent
4911The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4912@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4913first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4914they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4915@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4916@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4917
8f1732fc
AB
4918When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4919is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4920immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4921@smallexample
4922*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4923@end smallexample
4924@noindent
4925will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4926@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4927from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4928exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4929could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4930@smallexample
4931*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4932@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4933@noindent
4934Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4935before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4936all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4937@smallexample
4938EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4939@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4940
252b5132
RH
4941You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4942You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4943needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4944@smallexample
4945data.o(.data)
4946@end smallexample
4947
ae17ab41
CM
4948To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4949of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4950
4951Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4952
4953@smallexample
4954@group
4955SECTIONS @{
4956 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4957 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4958@}
4959@end group
4960@end smallexample
4961
4962In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4963input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4964@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4965@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4966whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4967
967928e9
AM
4968You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4969matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4970with no whitespace around the colon.
4971
4972@table @samp
4973@item archive:file
4974matches file within archive
4975@item archive:
4976matches the whole archive
4977@item :file
4978matches file but not one in an archive
4979@end table
4980
4981Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4982wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4983single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4984@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4985within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4986also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4987other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4988from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4989command.
4990
252b5132
RH
4991If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4992the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4993commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4994@smallexample
4995data.o
4996@end smallexample
4997
967928e9
AM
4998When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4999and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5000characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5001name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5002did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5003though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5004@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5005the archive search path.
5006
5007@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5008@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5009@cindex input section wildcards
5010@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5011@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5012@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5013In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5014name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5015
5016The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5017pattern for the file name.
5018
5019The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5020
5021@table @samp
5022@item *
5023matches any number of characters
5024@item ?
5025matches any single character
5026@item [@var{chars}]
5027matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5028character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5029@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5030@item \
5031quotes the following character
5032@end table
5033
252b5132
RH
5034File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5035specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5036does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5037
5038If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5039appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5040will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5041sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5042@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5043@smallexample
5044.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5045.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5046@end smallexample
5047
bcaa7b3e 5048@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5049Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5050in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5051this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5052pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5053@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5054into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5055
bcaa7b3e 5056@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5057@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5058@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5059alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5060alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5061needed.
bcaa7b3e 5062
02ecc8e9 5063@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5064@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5065@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5066numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5067section name before placing them in the output file. In
5068@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5069the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5070@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5071
bcaa7b3e
L
5072@cindex SORT
5073@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5074
5075When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5076can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5077
5078@enumerate
5079@item
5080@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5081It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5082sections have the same name.
5083@item
5084@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5085It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5086sections have the same alignment.
5087@item
c0065db7 5088@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5089treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5090@item
5091@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5092is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5093@item
5094All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5095@end enumerate
5096
a05a5b64 5097When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5098section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5099takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5100
5101If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5102command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5103treated as nested sorting command.
5104
5105@enumerate
5106@item
5107@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5108@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5109@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5110@item
5111@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5112@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5113@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5114@end enumerate
5115
5116If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5117command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5118
eda680f8 5119@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5120@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5121section sorting option.
5122
252b5132
RH
5123If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5124@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5125precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5126
5127This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5128files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5129sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5130The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5131with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5132linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5133@smallexample
5134@group
5135SECTIONS @{
5136 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5137 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5138 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5139 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5140@}
5141@end group
5142@end smallexample
5143
5144@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5145@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5146@cindex common symbol placement
5147@cindex uninitialized data placement
5148A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5149file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5150linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5151named @samp{COMMON}.
5152
5153You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5154other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5155particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5156input files are placed in another section.
5157
5158In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5159@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5160@smallexample
5161.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5162@end smallexample
5163
5164@cindex scommon section
5165@cindex small common symbols
5166Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5167example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5168symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5169different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5170the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5171symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5172to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5173locations.
5174
5175@cindex [COMMON]
5176You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5177notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5178@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5179
5180@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5181@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5182@cindex KEEP
5183@cindex garbage collection
5184When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5185it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5186This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5187with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5188@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5189
5190@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5191@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5192The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5193to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5194start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5195@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5196follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5197@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5198@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5199All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5200files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5201
5202@smallexample
5203@group
5204SECTIONS @{
5205 outputa 0x10000 :
5206 @{
5207 all.o
5208 foo.o (.input1)
5209 @}
36f63dca
NC
5210@end group
5211@group
252b5132
RH
5212 outputb :
5213 @{
5214 foo.o (.input2)
5215 foo1.o (.input1)
5216 @}
36f63dca
NC
5217@end group
5218@group
252b5132
RH
5219 outputc :
5220 @{
5221 *(.input1)
5222 *(.input2)
5223 @}
5224@}
5225@end group
a1ab1d2a 5226@end smallexample
252b5132 5227
cbd0eecf
L
5228If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5229and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5230automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5231__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5232indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5233respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5234C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5235
252b5132 5236@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5237@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5238@cindex data
5239@cindex section data
5240@cindex output section data
5241@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5242@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5243@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5244@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5245@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5246You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5247@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5248an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5249parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5250value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5251counter.
5252
5253The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5254store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5255bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5256stored.
5257
5258For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5259of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5260@smallexample
5261BYTE(1)
5262LONG(addr)
5263@end smallexample
5264
5265When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5266same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5267target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5268@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5269@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5270
5271If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5272which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5273When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5274true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5275endianness of the first input object file.
5276
36f63dca 5277Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5278between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5279@smallexample
5280SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5281@end smallexample
5282whereas this will work:
5283@smallexample
5284SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5285@end smallexample
5286
252b5132
RH
5287@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5288@cindex holes, filling
5289@cindex unspecified memory
5290You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5291current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5292otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5293gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5294with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5295necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5296point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5297than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5298different parts of an output section.
5299
5300This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5301value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5302@smallexample
563e308f 5303FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5304@end smallexample
5305
5306The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5307section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5308part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5309entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5310precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5311expression.
252b5132
RH
5312
5313@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5314@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5315There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5316commands.
5317
5318@table @code
5319@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5320@cindex input filename symbols
5321@cindex filename symbols
5322@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5323The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5324The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5325file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5326the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5327
5328This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5329normally used for any other object file format.
5330
5331@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5332@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5333@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5334@item CONSTRUCTORS
5335When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5336unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5337destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5338arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5339automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5340For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5341linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5342@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5343ignored for other object file formats.
5344
5345The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5346constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5347Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5348the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5349first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5350of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5351compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5352formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5353@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5354the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5355destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5356@code{exit}.
5357
5358For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5359arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5360addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5361and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5362linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5363runtime code expects to see.
5364
5365@smallexample
5366 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5367 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5368 *(.ctors)
5369 LONG(0)
5370 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5371 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5372 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5373 *(.dtors)
5374 LONG(0)
5375 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5376@end smallexample
5377
5378If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5379which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5380are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5381are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5382command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5383@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5384@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5385@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5386
5387Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5388and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5389need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5390scripts.
5391
5392@end table
5393
5394@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5395@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5396@cindex discarding sections
5397@cindex sections, discarding
5398@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5399The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5400This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5401may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5402@smallexample
49c13adb 5403.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5404@end smallexample
5405@noindent
5406will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5407@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5408sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5409space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5410too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5411space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5412@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5413@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5414This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5415
a0976ea4 5416The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5417on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5418symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5419the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5420section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5421
5422@cindex /DISCARD/
5423The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5424input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5425section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5426
99fabbc9
JL
5427This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5428@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5429garbage collection.
5430
a2e098c3
NC
5431Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5432discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5433members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5434Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5435
252b5132 5436@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5437@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5438@cindex output section attributes
5439We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5440like this:
0c71d759 5441
252b5132 5442@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5443@group
7e7d5768 5444@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5445 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5446 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5447 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5448 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5449 @{
5450 @var{output-section-command}
5451 @var{output-section-command}
5452 @dots{}
562d3460 5453 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5454@end group
5455@end smallexample
0c71d759 5456
252b5132
RH
5457We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5458@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5459remaining section attributes.
5460
a1ab1d2a 5461@menu
252b5132
RH
5462* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5463* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5464* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5465* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5466* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5467* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5468* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5469* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5470@end menu
5471
5472@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5473@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5474Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5475parentheses. The following types are defined:
5476
5477@table @code
5478@item NOLOAD
5479The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5480loaded into memory when the program is run.
6b86da53
LB
5481@item READONLY
5482The section should be marked as read-only.
252b5132
RH
5483@item DSECT
5484@itemx COPY
5485@itemx INFO
5486@itemx OVERLAY
5487These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5488rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5489marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5490section when the program is run.
5491@end table
5492
5493@kindex NOLOAD
5494@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5495@cindex loading, preventing
5496The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5497the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5498the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5499@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5500need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5501@smallexample
5502@group
5503SECTIONS @{
5504 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5505 @dots{}
5506@}
5507@end group
5508@end smallexample
5509
5510@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5511@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5512@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5513@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5514@cindex load address
5515@cindex section load address
5516Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5517@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5518@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5519specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5520address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5521
ea5cae92
NC
5522The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5523specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5524takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5525load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5526region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5527
5528If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5529section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5530load address:
5531
5532@itemize @bullet
5533@item
5534If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5535the LMA address as well.
5536
5537@item
5538If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5539
5540@item
5541Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5542with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5543section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5544VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5545the last section in the located region.
5546
5547@item
5548If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5549that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5550
5551@item
5552If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5553section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5554@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5555
5556@cindex ROM initialized data
5557@cindex initialized data in ROM
5558This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5559example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5560called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5561@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5562even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5563uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5564defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5565counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5566
5567@smallexample
5568@group
5569SECTIONS
5570 @{
5571 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5572 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5573 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5574 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5575 .bss 0x3000 :
5576 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5577@}
5578@end group
5579@end smallexample
5580
5581The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5582this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5583the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5584how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5585script.
5586
5587@smallexample
5588@group
5589extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5590char *src = &_etext;
5591char *dst = &_data;
5592
ea5cae92
NC
5593/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5594while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5595 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5596
ea5cae92 5597/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5598for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5599 *dst = 0;
5600@end group
5601@end smallexample
5602
bbf115d3
L
5603@node Forced Output Alignment
5604@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5605@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5606@cindex forcing output section alignment
5607@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5608You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5609alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5610intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5611
7e7d5768
AM
5612@node Forced Input Alignment
5613@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5614@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5615@cindex forcing input section alignment
5616@cindex input section alignment
5617You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5618SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5619sections, whether larger or smaller.
5620
0c71d759
NC
5621@node Output Section Constraint
5622@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5623@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5624@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5625@cindex constraints on output sections
5626You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5627of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5628read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5629@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5630
252b5132 5631@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5632@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5633@kindex >@var{region}
5634@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5635@cindex memory regions and sections
5636You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5637using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5638
5639Here is a simple example:
5640@smallexample
5641@group
5642MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5643SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5644@end group
5645@end smallexample
5646
5647@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5648@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5649@kindex :@var{phdr}
5650@cindex section, assigning to program header
5651@cindex program headers and sections
5652You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5653using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5654one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5655assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5656@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5657linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5658
5659Here is a simple example:
5660@smallexample
5661@group
5662PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5663SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5664@end group
5665@end smallexample
5666
5667@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5668@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5669@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5670@cindex section fill pattern
5671@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5672You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5673@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5674(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5675within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5676alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5677necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5678of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5679an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5680fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5681other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5682pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5683expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5684
5685You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5686output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5687
5688Here is a simple example:
5689@smallexample
5690@group
563e308f 5691SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5692@end group
5693@end smallexample
5694
5695@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5696@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5697@kindex OVERLAY
5698@cindex overlays
5699An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5700are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5701the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5702copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5703required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5704can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5705than another.
5706
5707Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5708@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5709output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5710command is as follows:
5711@smallexample
5712@group
5713OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5714 @{
5715 @var{secname1}
5716 @{
5717 @var{output-section-command}
5718 @var{output-section-command}
5719 @dots{}
5720 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5721 @var{secname2}
5722 @{
5723 @var{output-section-command}
5724 @var{output-section-command}
5725 @dots{}
5726 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5727 @dots{}
abc9061b 5728 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5729@end group
5730@end smallexample
5731
5732Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5733section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5734section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5735those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5736except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5737sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5738
abc9061b
CC
5739The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5740the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5741
252b5132
RH
5742The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5743addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5744memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5745whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5746and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5747and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5748
56dd11f0
NC
5749If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5750references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5751the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5752sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5753@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5754
5755For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5756provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5757defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5758@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5759the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5760within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5761symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5762
5763At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5764the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5765
5766Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5767@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5768@smallexample
5769@group
5770 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5771 @{
5772 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5773 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5774 @}
5775@end group
5776@end smallexample
5777@noindent
5778This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5779address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5780@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5781following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5782@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5783@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5784
5785C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5786like the following.
5787
5788@smallexample
5789@group
5790 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5791 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5792 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5793@end group
5794@end smallexample
5795
5796Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5797everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5798example could have been written identically as follows.
5799
5800@smallexample
5801@group
5802 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5803 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5804 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5805 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5806 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5807 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5808 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5809@end group
5810@end smallexample
5811
5812@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5813@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5814@kindex MEMORY
5815@cindex memory regions
5816@cindex regions of memory
5817@cindex allocating memory
5818@cindex discontinuous memory
5819The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5820memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5821
5822The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5823memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5824may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5825can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5826set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5827regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5828around to fit into the available regions.
5829
127fcdff
AB
5830A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5831however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5832specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5833@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5834@smallexample
5835@group
a1ab1d2a 5836MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5837 @{
5838 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5839 @dots{}
5840 @}
5841@end group
5842@end smallexample
5843
5844The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5845region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5846Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5847with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5848must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5849add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5850command.
252b5132
RH
5851
5852@cindex memory region attributes
5853The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5854whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5855not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5856@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5857section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5858the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5859them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5860
5861The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5862@table @samp
5863@item R
5864Read-only section
5865@item W
5866Read/write section
5867@item X
5868Executable section
5869@item A
5870Allocatable section
5871@item I
5872Initialized section
5873@item L
5874Same as @samp{I}
5875@item !
c09e9a8c 5876Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5877@end table
5878
81c688d5 5879If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5880@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5881attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5882unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5883not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5884string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5885or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5886the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5887
5888@kindex ORIGIN =
5889@kindex o =
5890@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5891The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5892the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5893cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5894abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5895@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5896
5897@kindex LENGTH =
5898@kindex len =
5899@kindex l =
5900The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5901region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5902be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5903@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5904
5905In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5906available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5907and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5908linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5909is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5910or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5911explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5912region.
5913
5914@smallexample
5915@group
a1ab1d2a 5916MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5917 @{
5918 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5919 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5920 @}
5921@end group
5922@end smallexample
5923
5924Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5925specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5926@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5927a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5928output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5929was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5930the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5931output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5932region, the linker will issue an error message.
5933
3ec57632 5934It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5935expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5936@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5937
5938@smallexample
5939@group
c0065db7 5940 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5941@end group
5942@end smallexample
5943
252b5132
RH
5944@node PHDRS
5945@section PHDRS Command
5946@kindex PHDRS
5947@cindex program headers
5948@cindex ELF program headers
5949@cindex program segments
5950@cindex segments, ELF
5951The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5952@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5953loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5954program with the @samp{-p} option.
5955
5956When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5957reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5958program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5959This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5960interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5961
5962The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5963in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5964precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5965the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5966not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5967
5968The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5969generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5970ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5971
5972This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5973@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5974
5975@smallexample
5976@group
5977PHDRS
5978@{
5979 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5980 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5981@}
5982@end group
5983@end smallexample
5984
5985The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5986of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5987header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5988with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5989must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5990is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5991
5992Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5993system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5994specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5995sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5996attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5997Section Phdr}.
5998
5999It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6000merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6001repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6002contain the section.
6003
6004If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6005then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6006not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6007convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6008placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6009default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6010segment at all.
6011
6012@kindex FILEHDR
6013@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6014You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6015the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6016The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6017file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6018include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6019segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6020these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6021
6022The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6023value of the keyword.
6024
6025@table @asis
6026@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6027Indicates an unused program header.
6028
6029@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6030Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6031the file.
6032
6033@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6034Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6035
6036@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6037Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6038found.
6039
6040@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6041Indicates a segment holding note information.
6042
6043@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6044A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6045ABI.
6046
6047@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6048Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6049
1a9ccd70
NC
6050@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6051Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6052
252b5132
RH
6053@item @var{expression}
6054An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6055be used for types not defined above.
6056@end table
6057
6058You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6059in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6060@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6061Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6062output section attribute.
6063
6064The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6065which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6066explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6067an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6068header.
6069
6070Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6071headers used on a native ELF system.
6072
6073@example
6074@group
6075PHDRS
6076@{
6077 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6078 interp PT_INTERP ;
6079 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6080 data PT_LOAD ;
6081 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6082@}
6083
6084SECTIONS
6085@{
6086 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6087 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6088 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6089 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6090 @dots{}
6091 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6092 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6093 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6094 @dots{}
6095@}
6096@end group
6097@end example
6098
6099@node VERSION
6100@section VERSION Command
6101@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6102@cindex symbol versions
6103@cindex version script
6104@cindex versions of symbols
6105The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6106only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6107symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6108a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6109shared library.
6110
6111You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6112you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6113also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6114
6115The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6116@smallexample
6117VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6118@end smallexample
6119
6120The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6121Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6122version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6123version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6124version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6125scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6126library.
6127
6128The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6129examples.
6130
6131@smallexample
6132VERS_1.1 @{
6133 global:
6134 foo1;
6135 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6136 old*;
6137 original*;
6138 new*;
252b5132
RH
6139@};
6140
6141VERS_1.2 @{
6142 foo2;
6143@} VERS_1.1;
6144
6145VERS_2.0 @{
6146 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6147 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6148 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6149 "f(int, double)";
6150 @};
252b5132
RH
6151@} VERS_1.2;
6152@end smallexample
6153
6154This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6155version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6156The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6157a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6158of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6159symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6160is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6161in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6162However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6163name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6164
6165Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6166depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6167to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6168
6169Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6170depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6171and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6172
6173When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6174specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6175unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6176unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6177somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6178wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6179wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6180set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6181ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6182
6183The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6184they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6185could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6186However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6187
0f6bf451 6188Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6189in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6190symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6191won't.
6192
6193@smallexample
7c9c73be 6194@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6195@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6196
252b5132
RH
6197When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6198symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6199requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6200shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6201loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6202linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6203application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6204way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6205all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6206search for each symbol reference.
6207
6208The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6209doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6210that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6211functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6212the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6213required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6214that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6215versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6216the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6217
6218There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6219first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6220source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6221script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6222maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6223@smallexample
6224__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6225@end smallexample
6226@noindent
6227in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6228be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6229The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6230@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6231takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6232
6233The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6234function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6235an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6236version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6237linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6238
6239To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6240source file. Here is an example:
6241
6242@smallexample
6243__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6244__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6245__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6246__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6247@end smallexample
6248
6249In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6250unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6251example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6252@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6253
6254When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6255some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6256this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6257@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6258declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6259you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6260
6261If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6262within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6263(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6264specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6265
cb840a31
L
6266You can also specify the language in the version script:
6267
6268@smallexample
6269VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6270@end smallexample
6271
c0065db7 6272The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6273The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6274demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6275patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6276@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6277
86043bbb
MM
6278Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6279described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6280or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6281the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6282whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6283cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6284might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6285should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6286expect when you upgrade.
6287
252b5132
RH
6288@node Expressions
6289@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6290@cindex expressions
6291@cindex arithmetic
6292The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6293that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6294places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6295evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6296size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6297otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6298
6299You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6300
6301The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6302expressions.
6303
6304@menu
6305* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6306* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6307* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6308* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6309* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6310* Operators:: Operators
6311* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6312* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6313* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6314@end menu
6315
6316@node Constants
6317@subsection Constants
6318@cindex integer notation
6319@cindex constants in linker scripts
6320All constants are integers.
6321
6322As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6323octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6324hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6325@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6326@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6327value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6328
6329@cindex scaled integers
6330@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6331@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6332@cindex suffixes for integers
6333@cindex integer suffixes
6334In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6335constant by
6336@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6337@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6338@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6339@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6340@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6341@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6342@tex
6343${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6344@end tex
6345@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6346respectively. For example, the following
6347all refer to the same quantity:
6348
252b5132 6349@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6350_fourk_1 = 4K;
6351_fourk_2 = 4096;
6352_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6353_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6354@end smallexample
6355
8a308ae8
NC
6356Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6357conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6358
0c71d759
NC
6359@node Symbolic Constants
6360@subsection Symbolic Constants
6361@cindex symbolic constants
6362@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6363It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6364the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6365
6366@table @code
6367@item MAXPAGESIZE
6368@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6369The target's maximum page size.
6370
6371@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6372@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6373The target's default page size.
6374@end table
6375
6376So for example:
6377
6378@smallexample
9d5777a3 6379 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6380@end smallexample
6381
6382will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6383supported by the target.
6384
252b5132
RH
6385@node Symbols
6386@subsection Symbol Names
6387@cindex symbol names
6388@cindex names
6389@cindex quoted symbol names
6390@kindex "
6391Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6392and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6393Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6394specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6395keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6396@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6397"SECTION" = 9;
6398"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6399@end smallexample
6400
6401Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6402to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6403whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6404
ecca9871
L
6405@node Orphan Sections
6406@subsection Orphan Sections
6407@cindex orphan
6408Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6409are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6410script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6411output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6412in which to place the orphaned input section.
6413
6414If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6415an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6416placed at the end of that output section.
6417
6418If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6419sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6420name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6421orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6422one new output section.
6423
6424If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6425then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6426in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6427linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6428attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6429sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6430support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6431
a05a5b64
TP
6432The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6433(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6434output sections an orphan is placed in.
6435
252b5132
RH
6436@node Location Counter
6437@subsection The Location Counter
6438@kindex .
6439@cindex dot
6440@cindex location counter
6441@cindex current output location
6442The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6443current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6444location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6445within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6446anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6447
6448@cindex holes
6449Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6450moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6451location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6452and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6453doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6454
6455@smallexample
6456SECTIONS
6457@{
6458 output :
6459 @{
6460 file1(.text)
6461 . = . + 1000;
6462 file2(.text)
6463 . += 1000;
6464 file3(.text)
563e308f 6465 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6466@}
6467@end smallexample
6468@noindent
6469In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6470located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6471followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6472@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6473@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6474specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6475
5c6bbab8
NC
6476@cindex dot inside sections
6477Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6478current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6479statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6480absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6481however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6482not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6483
6484@smallexample
6485SECTIONS
6486@{
6487 . = 0x100
6488 .text: @{
6489 *(.text)
6490 . = 0x200
6491 @}
6492 . = 0x500
6493 .data: @{
6494 *(.data)
6495 . += 0x600
6496 @}
6497@}
6498@end smallexample
6499
6500The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6501and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6502the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6503much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6504move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6505and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6506the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6507the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6508
b5666f2f
AM
6509@cindex dot outside sections
6510Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6511output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6512needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6513
6514@smallexample
6515SECTIONS
6516@{
6517 start_of_text = . ;
6518 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6519 end_of_text = . ;
6520
6521 start_of_data = . ;
6522 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6523 end_of_data = . ;
6524@}
6525@end smallexample
6526
6527If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6528not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6529between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6530should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6531blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6532the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6533sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6534statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6535special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6536place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6537as follows:
6538
6539@smallexample
6540SECTIONS
6541@{
6542 start_of_text = . ;
6543 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6544 end_of_text = . ;
6545
6546 start_of_data = . ;
6547 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6548 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6549 end_of_data = . ;
6550@}
6551@end smallexample
6552
6553This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6554@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6555placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6556assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6557a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6558section. So you could write:
6559
6560@smallexample
6561SECTIONS
6562@{
6563 start_of_text = . ;
6564 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6565 end_of_text = . ;
6566
6567 . = . ;
6568 start_of_data = . ;
6569 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6570 end_of_data = . ;
6571@}
6572@end smallexample
6573
6574Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6575@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6576
252b5132
RH
6577@need 2000
6578@node Operators
6579@subsection Operators
6580@cindex operators for arithmetic
6581@cindex arithmetic operators
6582@cindex precedence in expressions
6583The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6584the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6585@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6586@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6587@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6588@smallexample
6589precedence associativity Operators Notes
6590(highest)
65911 left ! - ~ (1)
65922 left * / %
65933 left + -
65944 left >> <<
65955 left == != > < <= >=
65966 left &
65977 left |
65988 left &&
65999 left ||
660010 right ? :
660111 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6602(lowest)
6603@end smallexample
6604Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6605(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6606(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6607@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6608@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6609@tex
6610\vskip \baselineskip
6611%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6612\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6613\hrule
6614\halign
6615{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6616height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6617&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6618height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6619\noalign{\hrule}
6620height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6621&highest&&&&&\cr
6622% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6623&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6624&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6625&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6626&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6627&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6628&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6629&7&&left&&|&\cr
6630&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6631&9&&left&&||&\cr
6632&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6633&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6634&lowest&&&&&\cr
6635height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6636\hrule}
6637@end tex
6638@iftex
6639{
6640@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6641@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6642@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6643}
6644@end iftex
6645@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6646
6647@node Evaluation
6648@subsection Evaluation
6649@cindex lazy evaluation
6650@cindex expression evaluation order
6651The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6652an expression when absolutely necessary.
6653
6654The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6655address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6656regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6657as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6658
6659However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6660until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6661other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6662for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6663
6664The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6665assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6666allocation.
6667
6668Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6669@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6670
6671If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6672available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6673following
6674@smallexample
6675@group
6676SECTIONS
6677 @{
a1ab1d2a 6678 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6679 @{ *(.text) @}
6680 @}
6681@end group
6682@end smallexample
6683@noindent
6684will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6685address}.
6686
6687@node Expression Section
6688@subsection The Section of an Expression
6689@cindex expression sections
6690@cindex absolute expressions
6691@cindex relative expressions
6692@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6693@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6694@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6695Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6696relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6697using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6698value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6699symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6700operations.
6701
abf4be64
AM
6702Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6703section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6704address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6705@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6706functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6707One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6708(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6709differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6710versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6711section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6712Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6713absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6714given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6715everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6716
6717In the following simple example,
252b5132 6718
7542af2a
AM
6719@smallexample
6720@group
6721SECTIONS
6722 @{
6723 . = 0x100;
6724 __executable_start = 0x100;
6725 .data :
6726 @{
6727 . = 0x10;
6728 __data_start = 0x10;
6729 *(.data)
6730 @}
6731 @dots{}
6732 @}
6733@end group
6734@end smallexample
252b5132 6735
7542af2a
AM
6736both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6737address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6738@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6739section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6740
5c3049d2
AM
6741For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6742addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6743
6744@itemize @bullet
6745@item
c05f749e
AM
6746Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6747operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6748absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6749@item
7542af2a
AM
6750Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6751relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6752and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6753@item
c05f749e
AM
6754Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6755in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6756address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6757before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6758@end itemize
6759
6760The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6761
6762@itemize @bullet
6763@item
6764An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6765@item
6766The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6767@item
9bc8bb33 6768The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6769relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6770(after above conversions) is also a number when
6771@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6772but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6773@item
6774The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6775relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6776section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6777@item
6778The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6779conversions) is an absolute address.
6780@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6781
6782You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6783to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6784create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6785section @samp{.data}:
6786@smallexample
6787SECTIONS
6788 @{
6789 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6790 @}
6791@end smallexample
6792@noindent
6793If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6794@samp{.data} section.
6795
7542af2a
AM
6796Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6797particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6798
252b5132
RH
6799@node Builtin Functions
6800@subsection Builtin Functions
6801@cindex functions in expressions
6802The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6803use in linker script expressions.
6804
6805@table @code
6806@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6807@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6808@cindex expression, absolute
6809Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6810of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6811value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6812normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6813
6814@item ADDR(@var{section})
6815@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6816@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6817Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6818script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6819the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6820@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6821@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6822the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6823@smallexample
6824@group
6825SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6826 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6827 @{
252b5132
RH
6828 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6829 @dots{}
6830 @}
6831 .output :
6832 @{
6833 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6834 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6835 @}
6836@dots{} @}
6837@end group
6838@end smallexample
6839
876f4090
NS
6840@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6841@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6842@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6843@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6844@cindex round up location counter
6845@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6846@cindex round up expression
6847@cindex align expression
6848Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6849to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6850doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6851arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6852expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6853equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6854
6855Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6856next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6857variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6858input sections:
252b5132
RH
6859@smallexample
6860@group
6861SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6862 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6863 *(.data)
6864 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6865 @}
6866@dots{} @}
6867@end group
6868@end smallexample
6869@noindent
6870The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6871a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6872a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6873of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6874
6875The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6876
362c1d1a
NS
6877@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6878@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6879@cindex section alignment
6880Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6881been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6882evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6883the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6884value in that section.
6885@smallexample
6886@group
6887SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6888 .output @{
6889 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6890 @dots{}
6891 @}
6892@dots{} @}
6893@end group
6894@end smallexample
6895
252b5132
RH
6896@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6897@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6898This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6899scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6900section.
6901
2d20f7bf
JJ
6902@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6903@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6904This is equivalent to either
6905@smallexample
6906(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6907@end smallexample
6908or
6909@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6910(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6911 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6912@end smallexample
6913@noindent
6914depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6915for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6916@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6917If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6918memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6919bytes in the on-disk file.
6920
6921This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6922any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6923@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6924be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6925running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6926that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6927page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6928
6929@noindent
6930Example:
6931@smallexample
6932 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6933@end smallexample
6934
6935@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6936@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6937This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6938evaluation purposes.
6939
6940@smallexample
6941 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6942@end smallexample
6943
a4f5ad88
JJ
6944@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6945@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6946This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6947@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6948When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6949does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6950@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6951argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6952script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6953@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6954padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6955section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6956
6957@smallexample
6958 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6959@end smallexample
6960
252b5132
RH
6961@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6962@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6963@cindex symbol defaults
6964Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6965defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6966return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6967default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6968shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6969the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6970existed, its value is preserved:
6971
6972@smallexample
6973@group
6974SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6975 .text : @{
6976 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6977 @dots{}
6978 @}
6979 @dots{}
6980@}
6981@end group
6982@end smallexample
6983
3ec57632
NC
6984@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6985@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6986Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6987
252b5132
RH
6988@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6989@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6990@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6991Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6992Section LMA}).
6993
2e53f7d6
NC
6994@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6995@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6996Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6997@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6998
252b5132
RH
6999@kindex MAX
7000@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7001Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7002
7003@kindex MIN
7004@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7005Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7006
7007@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7008@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7009@cindex unallocated address, next
7010Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7011This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7012use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7013output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7014
3ec57632
NC
7015@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7016@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7017Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7018
ba916c8a
MM
7019@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7020@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7021Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7022value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7023@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7024will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7025can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7026``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7027name.
7028
252b5132
RH
7029@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7030@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7031@cindex section size
7032Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7033been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7034evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7035@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7036@smallexample
7037@group
7038SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7039 .output @{
7040 .start = . ;
7041 @dots{}
7042 .end = . ;
7043 @}
7044 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7045 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7046@dots{} @}
7047@end group
7048@end smallexample
7049
7050@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7051@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7052@cindex header size
7053Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7054information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7055this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7056choose, to facilitate paging.
7057
7058@cindex not enough room for program headers
7059@cindex program headers, not enough room
7060When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7061@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7062number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7063addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7064additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7065room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7066the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7067script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7068you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7069command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7070@end table
7071
7072@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7073@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7074@cindex implicit linker scripts
7075If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7076an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7077linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7078linker will report an error.
7079
7080An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7081
7082Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7083assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7084commands.
7085
7086Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7087at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7088read. This can affect archive searching.
7089
bf6d8037
HC
7090@node Plugins
7091@chapter Linker Plugins
7092
7093@cindex plugins
7094@cindex linker plugins
7095The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7096For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7097support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7098
7099Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7100be added here later.
7101
7102@menu
7103* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7104@end menu
7105
7106@node libdep Plugin
7107@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7108@cindex static library dependencies
7109Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7110just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7111optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7112within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7113rose to ascendance.
7114
7115One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7116multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7117dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7118library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7119referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7120link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7121libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7122explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7123
7124The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7125to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7126plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7127dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7128and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7129command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7130utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7131being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7132archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7133
7134For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7135library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7136the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7137
7138@smallexample
7139-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7140@end smallexample
7141
252b5132
RH
7142@ifset GENERIC
7143@node Machine Dependent
7144@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7145
7146@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7147@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7148sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7149functionality are not listed.
7150
7151@menu
36f63dca
NC
7152@ifset H8300
7153* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7154@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7155@ifset M68HC11
7156* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7157@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7158@ifset ARM
7159* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7160@end ifset
7161@ifset HPPA
7162* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7163@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7164@ifset M68K
7165* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7166@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7167@ifset MIPS
7168* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7169@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7170@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7171* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7172@end ifset
2469cfa2 7173@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7174* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7175@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7176@ifset NDS32
7177* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7178@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7179@ifset NIOSII
7180* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7181@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7182@ifset POWERPC
7183* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7184@end ifset
7185@ifset POWERPC64
7186* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7187@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7188@ifset S/390
7189* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7190@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7191@ifset SPU
7192* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7193@end ifset
74459f0e 7194@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7195* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7196@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7197@ifset WIN32
7198* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7199@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7200@ifset XTENSA
7201* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7202@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7203@end menu
7204@end ifset
7205
252b5132
RH
7206@ifset H8300
7207@ifclear GENERIC
7208@raisesections
7209@end ifclear
7210
7211@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7212@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7213
7214@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7215For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7216you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7217
7218@table @emph
7219@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7220@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7221@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7222targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7223program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7224respectively.
7225
7226@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7227@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7228@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7229@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7230sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7231page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7232(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7233@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7234top page of memory).
1502569c 7235
81f5558e
NC
7236@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7237indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7238displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7239the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7240@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7241whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7242range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7243
1502569c 7244@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7245@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7246biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7247which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7248page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7249(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7250@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7251the top page of memory).
7252
7253@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7254@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
725532 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7256changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7257(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7258@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7259the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7260@end table
7261
7262@ifclear GENERIC
7263@lowersections
7264@end ifclear
7265@end ifset
7266
36f63dca 7267@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7268@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7269@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7270@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7271@node Renesas
7272@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7273
c2dcd04e
NC
7274@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7275H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7276options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7277@end ifset
7278@end ifclear
7279
36f63dca
NC
7280@ifset ARM
7281@ifclear GENERIC
7282@raisesections
7283@end ifclear
7284
93fd0973
SC
7285@ifset M68HC11
7286@ifclear GENERIC
7287@raisesections
7288@end ifclear
7289
7290@node M68HC11/68HC12
7291@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7292
7293@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7294
7295@subsection Linker Relaxation
7296
7297For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7298optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7299
7300@table @emph
7301@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7302@item relaxing address modes
7303@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7304targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7305program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7306respectively.
7307
7308@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7309transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7310page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7311
7312@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7313When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7314of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7315addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7316@code{bset} instructions.
7317
7318@end table
7319
7320@subsection Trampoline Generation
7321
7322@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7323@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7324For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7325call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7326will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7327trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7328case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7329point to the function trampoline.
7330
7331@ifclear GENERIC
7332@lowersections
7333@end ifclear
7334@end ifset
7335
36f63dca 7336@node ARM
3674e28a 7337@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7338
7339@cindex ARM interworking support
7340@kindex --support-old-code
7341For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7342between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7343been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7344line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7345libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7346option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7347given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7348which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7349the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7350non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7351
7352@cindex thumb entry point
7353@cindex entry point, thumb
7354@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7355The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7356@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7357But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7358branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7359executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7360
ce11ba6c
KT
7361@cindex PE import table prefixing
7362@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7363The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7364the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7365element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7366import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7367
e489d0ae
PB
7368@cindex BE8
7369@kindex --be8
7370The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7371executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7372objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7373option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7374little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7375
3674e28a
PB
7376@cindex TARGET1
7377@kindex --target1-rel
7378@kindex --target1-abs
7379The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7380@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7381or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7382and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7383
7384@cindex TARGET2
7385@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7386The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7387@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7388meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7389@table @samp
7390@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7391@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7392@item abs
a57d1773 7393@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7394@item got-rel
7395@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7396@end table
7397
319850b4
JB
7398@cindex FIX_V4BX
7399@kindex --fix-v4bx
7400The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7401specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7402interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7403also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7404
7405In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7406linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7407@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7408
7409In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7410relocations are ignored.
7411
845b51d6
PB
7412@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7413@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7414Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7415relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7416
7417@smallexample
7418TST rM, #1
7419MOVEQ PC, rM
7420BX Rn
7421@end smallexample
7422
7423This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7424and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7425condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7426
33bfe774
JB
7427@cindex USE_BLX
7428@kindex --use-blx
7429The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7430BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7431situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7432code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7433each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7434
c6dd86c6
JB
7435@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7436@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7437The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7438bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7439instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7440to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7441the support code can read the intended values.
7442
7443The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7444intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7445and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7446intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7447full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7448you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7449
7450If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7451enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7452@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7453mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7454vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7455@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7456
7457If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7458potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7459such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7460first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7461instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7462the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7463are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7464
2de70689
MGD
7465@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7466@kindex --fix-arm1176
7467@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7468The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7469in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7470are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7471unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7472
9d5777a3 7473Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7474Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7475http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7476
a504d23a
LA
7477@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7478@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7479
7480The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7481workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7482the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7483off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7484the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7485core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7486integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7487VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7488
7489The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7490necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7491
7492The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7493@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7494STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7495linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7496@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7497
7498If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7499potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7500such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7501replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7502branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7503then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7504
7505The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7506the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7507
7508The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7509they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7510there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7511occurs.
7512
7513The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7514PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7515large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7516cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7517occurs.
7518
bf21ed78
MS
7519@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7520@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7521The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7522warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7523enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7524linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7525using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7526not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7527
7528@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7529@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7530The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7531warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7532@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7533linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7534using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7535
726150b7
NC
7536@cindex PIC_VENEER
7537@kindex --pic-veneer
7538The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7539ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7540is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7541@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7542
7543@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7544@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7545The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7546code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7547perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7548placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7549controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7550The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7551duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7552group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7553code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7554where they should be placed.
7555
7556The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7557@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7558placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7559branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7560placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7561value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7562exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7563A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7564linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7565from the input sections.
7566
7567The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7568@samp{N = +1}.
7569
1a51c1a4
NC
7570Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7571only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7572otherwise.
7573
1db37fe6
YG
7574@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7575@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7576@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7577The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7578
7579The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7580
68fcca92
JW
7581@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7582@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7583@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7584The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7585
7586Please contact ARM for further details.
7587
1db37fe6
YG
7588@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7589@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7590@cindex Merging exidx entries
7591The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7592
7593@kindex --long-plt
7594@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7595The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7596which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7597entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7598
1f56df9d
JW
7599@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7600@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7601The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7602link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7603
4ba2ef8f
TP
7604@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7605All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7606Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7607@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7608veneers in memory.
7609
54ddd295
TP
7610@kindex --cmse-implib
7611@cindex Secure gateway import library
7612The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7613specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7614secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7615executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7616
0955507f
TP
7617@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7618@cindex Input import library
7619The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7620must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7621given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7622in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7623@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7624library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7625library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7626for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7627specified.
7628
36f63dca
NC
7629@ifclear GENERIC
7630@lowersections
7631@end ifclear
7632@end ifset
7633
7634@ifset HPPA
7635@ifclear GENERIC
7636@raisesections
7637@end ifclear
7638
7639@node HPPA ELF32
7640@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7641@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7642@kindex --multi-subspace
7643When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7644import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7645The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7646stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7647multiple sub-spaces.
7648
7649@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7650@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7651Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7652stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7653@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7654sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7655a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7656the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7657conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7658prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7659A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7660branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7661@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7662@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7663detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7664positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7665
7666Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7667single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7668create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7669large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7670
7671@ifclear GENERIC
7672@lowersections
7673@end ifclear
7674@end ifset
7675
7fb9f789
NC
7676@ifset M68K
7677@ifclear GENERIC
7678@raisesections
7679@end ifclear
7680
7681@node M68K
7682@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7683
7684@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7685@kindex --got=@var{type}
7686The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7687The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7688@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7689the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7690@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7691entries only at non-negative offsets.
7692@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7693entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7694support such GOTs.
7695@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7696output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7697file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7698files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7699
7700@ifclear GENERIC
7701@lowersections
7702@end ifclear
7703@end ifset
7704
833794fc
MR
7705@ifset MIPS
7706@ifclear GENERIC
7707@raisesections
7708@end ifclear
7709
7710@node MIPS
7711@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7712
7713@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7714@kindex --insn32
7715@kindex --no-insn32
7716The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7717microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7718in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7719used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7720or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7721including 16-bit ones where possible.
7722
8b10b0b3
MR
7723@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7724@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7725@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7726The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7727control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7728@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7729relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7730calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7731relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7732instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7733or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7734the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7735
833794fc
MR
7736@ifclear GENERIC
7737@lowersections
7738@end ifclear
7739@end ifset
7740
36f63dca
NC
7741@ifset MMIX
7742@ifclear GENERIC
7743@raisesections
7744@end ifclear
7745
7746@node MMIX
7747@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7748For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7749@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7750understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7751can translate between the two formats.
7752
7753There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7754Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7755registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7756equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7757@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7758global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7759this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7760symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7761
7a2de473
HPN
7762Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7763@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7764The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7765of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7766
7767Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7768are left out from an mmo file.
7769
7770@ifclear GENERIC
7771@lowersections
7772@end ifclear
7773@end ifset
7774
7775@ifset MSP430
7776@ifclear GENERIC
7777@raisesections
7778@end ifclear
7779
7780@node MSP430
7781@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7782For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7783will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7784just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7785
7786@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7787The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7788
7789@table @code
7790@item @samp{.vectors}
7791Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7792
7793@item @samp{.bootloader}
7794Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7795in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7796
7797@item @samp{.infomem}
7798Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7799this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7800
c0065db7 7801@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7802This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7803in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7804
7805@item @samp{.noinit}
7806Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7807
c0065db7 7808The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7809@end table
7810
7ef3addb
JL
7811@table @option
7812@cindex MSP430 Options
7813@kindex --code-region
7814@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7815This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7816argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7817using this option.
7818
7819@kindex --data-region
7820@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7821This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7822[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7823for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7824
7825@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7826@item --disable-sec-transformation
7827Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7828and @code{--data-region} options.
7829This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7830wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7831not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7832@end table
7833
36f63dca
NC
7834@ifclear GENERIC
7835@lowersections
7836@end ifclear
7837@end ifset
7838
35c08157
KLC
7839@ifset NDS32
7840@ifclear GENERIC
7841@raisesections
7842@end ifclear
7843
7844@node NDS32
7845@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7846@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7847For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7848relaxes objects according to these options.
7849
7850@table @code
7851@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7852Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7853
7854@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7855Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7856
7857@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7858Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7859
7860@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7861Export the EX9 table after linking.
7862
7863@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7864Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7865
7866@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7867Update the existing EX9 table.
7868
7869@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7870Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7871
7872@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7873Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7874
7875@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7876Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7877
7878@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7879Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7880@end table
7881
7882@ifclear GENERIC
7883@lowersections
7884@end ifclear
7885@end ifset
7886
78058a5e
SL
7887@ifset NIOSII
7888@ifclear GENERIC
7889@raisesections
7890@end ifclear
7891
7892@node Nios II
7893@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7894@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7895@kindex --relax on Nios II
7896
7897Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7898transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7899which may result in @command{ld} giving
7900@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7901The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7902trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7903outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7904trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7905be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7906larger than 256MB.
7907
7908The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7909is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7910@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7911locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7912source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7913register as a temporary.
7914
7915Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7916relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7917option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7918
7919@ifclear GENERIC
7920@lowersections
7921@end ifclear
7922@end ifset
7923
2a60a7a8
AM
7924@ifset POWERPC
7925@ifclear GENERIC
7926@raisesections
7927@end ifclear
7928
7929@node PowerPC ELF32
7930@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7931@cindex PowerPC long branches
7932@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7933Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7934displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7935@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7936@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7937the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7938section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7939section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7940@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7941both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7942considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7943
7944@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7945@table @option
7946@cindex PowerPC PLT
7947@kindex --bss-plt
7948@item --bss-plt
7949Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7950generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7951the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7952writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7953@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7954PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7955compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7956BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7957
016687f8
AM
7958@kindex --secure-plt
7959@item --secure-plt
7960@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7961@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7962when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7963layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7964style BSS PLT.
7965
2a60a7a8
AM
7966@cindex PowerPC GOT
7967@kindex --sdata-got
7968@item --sdata-got
7969The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7970sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7971@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7972section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7973@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7974@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7975@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7976@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7977PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7978pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7979GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7980really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7981
7982@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7983@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7984@item --emit-stub-syms
7985This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7986symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7987
7988@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7989@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7990@item --no-tls-optimize
7991PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7992sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7993disable the optimization.
7994@end table
7995
7996@ifclear GENERIC
7997@lowersections
7998@end ifclear
7999@end ifset
8000
8001@ifset POWERPC64
8002@ifclear GENERIC
8003@raisesections
8004@end ifclear
8005
8006@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8007@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8008
8009@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8010@table @option
8011@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8012@kindex --stub-group-size
8013@item --stub-group-size
8014Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8015by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8016@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8017sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8018a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8019the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8020conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8021prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8022A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8023branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8024@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8025@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8026detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8027positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8028
8029Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8030single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8031create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8032large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8033
8034@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8035@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8036@item --emit-stub-syms
8037This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8038symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8039
8040@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8041@kindex --dotsyms
8042@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8043@item --dotsyms
8044@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8045These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8046in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8047function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8048code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8049properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8050to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8051@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8052dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8053feature.
8054
7ae4ea7d
AM
8055@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8056@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8057@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8058@item --save-restore-funcs
8059@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8060These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8061provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8062@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8063function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8064link.
8065
2a60a7a8
AM
8066@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8067@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8068@item --no-tls-optimize
8069PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8070sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8071disable the optimization.
8072
7c9cf415
AM
8073@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8074@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8075@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8076@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8077@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8078@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8079@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8080These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8081stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8082an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8083@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8084stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8085generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8086__tls_get_addr_opt.
8087Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8088much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8089an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8090will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8091@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8092and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8093this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8094Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8095@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8096register saves.
7c9cf415 8097
2a60a7a8
AM
8098@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8099@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8100@item --no-opd-optimize
8101PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8102corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8103the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8104Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8105
8106@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8107@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8108@item --non-overlapping-opd
8109Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8110@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8111the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8112entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8113
8114@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8115@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8116@item --no-toc-optimize
8117PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8118entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8119reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8120marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8121marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8122relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8123unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8124reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8125discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8126reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8127code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8128optimization.
8129
d882c988
AM
8130@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8131@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8132@item --no-inline-optimize
8133PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8134marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8135@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8136a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8137locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8138disables that optimization.
8139
2a60a7a8
AM
8140@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8141@kindex --no-multi-toc
8142@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8143If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8144@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8145where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8146entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8147total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8148grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8149TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8150calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8151help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
815264K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8153Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8154
8155@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8156@kindex --no-toc-sort
8157@item --no-toc-sort
8158By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8159happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8160placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8161with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8162referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8163@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8164results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8165off this feature.
8166
8167@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8168@kindex --plt-align
8169@kindex --no-plt-align
8170@item --plt-align
8171@itemx --no-plt-align
8172Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8173aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8174boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8175specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8176specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8177if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8178PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8179
8180@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8181@kindex --plt-static-chain
8182@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8183@item --plt-static-chain
8184@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8185Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8186chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8187chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8188
8189@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8190@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8191@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8192@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8193@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8194With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8195lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8196another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8197order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8198memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8199barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8200looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8201seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8202default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8203
8204@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8205@kindex --plt-localentry
8206@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8207@item --plt-localentry
8208@itemx --no-localentry
8209ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8210ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8211(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8212Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8213or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8214functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8215in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8216interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8217including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8218to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8219complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8220care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8221
8222@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8223@kindex --power10-stubs
8224@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8225@item --power10-stubs
8226@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8227When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8228relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8229linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8230for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8231power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8232power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8233allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8234@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8235auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8236@end table
8237
8238@ifclear GENERIC
8239@lowersections
8240@end ifclear
8241@end ifset
8242
b4cbbe8f
AK
8243@ifset S/390
8244@ifclear GENERIC
8245@raisesections
8246@end ifclear
8247
8248@node S/390 ELF
8249@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8250
8251@cindex S/390 ELF options
8252@table @option
8253
8254@cindex S/390
8255@kindex --s390-pgste
8256@item --s390-pgste
8257This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8258segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8259binaries marked that way.
8260@end table
8261
8262@ifclear GENERIC
8263@lowersections
8264@end ifclear
8265@end ifset
8266
49fa1e15
AM
8267@ifset SPU
8268@ifclear GENERIC
8269@raisesections
8270@end ifclear
8271
8272@node SPU ELF
8273@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8274
8275@cindex SPU ELF options
8276@table @option
8277
8278@cindex SPU plugins
8279@kindex --plugin
8280@item --plugin
8281This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8282
8283@cindex SPU overlays
8284@kindex --no-overlays
8285@item --no-overlays
8286Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8287regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8288@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8289turns off all this special overlay handling.
8290
8291@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8292@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8293@item --emit-stub-syms
8294This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8295symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8296
8297@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8298@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8299@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8300This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8301function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8302on calls to non-overlay regions.
8303
8304@cindex SPU local store size
8305@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8306@item --local-store=lo:hi
8307@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8308the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8309range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8310
c0065db7 8311@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8312@kindex --stack-analysis
8313@item --stack-analysis
8314SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8315unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8316under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8317@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8318@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8319determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8320for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8321for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8322for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8323find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8324and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8325under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8326dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8327is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8328and calls will be given.
8329
c0065db7 8330@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8331@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8332@item --emit-stack-syms
8333This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8334in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8335These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8336functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8337functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8338such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8339The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8340@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8341@end table
8342
8343@ifclear GENERIC
8344@lowersections
8345@end ifclear
8346@end ifset
8347
36f63dca
NC
8348@ifset TICOFF
8349@ifclear GENERIC
8350@raisesections
8351@end ifclear
8352
8353@node TI COFF
8354@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8355@cindex TI COFF versions
8356@kindex --format=@var{version}
8357The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8358TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8359also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8360format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8361header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8362
8363@ifclear GENERIC
8364@lowersections
8365@end ifclear
8366@end ifset
8367
2ca22b03
NC
8368@ifset WIN32
8369@ifclear GENERIC
8370@raisesections
8371@end ifclear
8372
8373@node WIN32
8374@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8375
c0065db7 8376This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8377See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8378command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8379
8380@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8381@cindex import libraries
8382@item import libraries
69da35b5 8383The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8384libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8385regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8386archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8387support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8388@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8389
c0065db7
RM
8390@item exporting DLL symbols
8391@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8392The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8393
8394@table @emph
8395@item using auto-export functionality
8396@cindex using auto-export functionality
8397By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8398which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8399
0a5d968e
NC
8400@itemize
8401@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8402@item --exclude-symbols
8403@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8404@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8405@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8406@end itemize
8407
09e2aba4
DK
8408When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8409(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8410symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8411often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8412private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8413options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8414exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8415final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8416
8417If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8418command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8419if either of the following are true:
8420
8421@itemize
8422@item A DEF file is used.
8423@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8424@end itemize
dc8465bf 8425
c0065db7
RM
8426@item using a DEF file
8427@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8428Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8429an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8430exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8431name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8432command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8433
8434@example
8435gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8436@end example
8437
0a5d968e
NC
8438Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8439@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8440
dc8465bf
NC
8441Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8442
8443@example
4b5bd4e7 8444LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8445
8446EXPORTS
8447foo
8448bar
8449_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8450another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8451var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8452doo = foo == foo2
8453eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8454@end example
dc8465bf 8455
7fcab871 8456This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8457symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8458alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8459by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8460@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8461@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8462export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8463in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8464symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8465
6b31ad16
DS
8466The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8467name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8468the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8469
b45619c0
NC
8470When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8471library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8472@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8473executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8474
8475With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8476specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8477non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8478
8479If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8480or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8481filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8482
4b5bd4e7
DS
8483The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8484
8485@example
8486EXPORTS
8487 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8488 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8489 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8490@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8491
8492Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8493@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8494@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8495@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8496Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8497@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8498string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8499
8500The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8501
8502@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8503will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8504by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8505linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8506library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8507
8508@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8509The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8510the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8511@code{*_imp__foo}).
8512
8513@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8514well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8515read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8516variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8517the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8518extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8519application will behave unexpectedly.
8520
8521@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8522it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8523symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8524API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8525the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8526
4b5bd4e7
DS
8527See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8528other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8529
8530@cindex creating a DEF file
8531While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8532with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8533
8534@item Using decorations
8535@cindex Using decorations
8536Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8537itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8538declared as:
8539
8540@example
8541__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8542__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8543@end example
8544
8545All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8546any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8547this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8548the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8549
8550Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8551decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8552instead:
8553
8554@example
8555__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8556__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8557@end example
8558
c0065db7
RM
8559This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8560when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8561variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8562code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8563of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8564omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8565@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8566information.
c0065db7 8567@end table
dc8465bf 8568
2ca22b03
NC
8569@cindex automatic data imports
8570@item automatic data imports
8571The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8572by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8573compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8574issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8575code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8576c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8577initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8578decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8579platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8580command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8581The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8582suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8583trigger the feature's use.
8584
c0065db7 8585auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8586additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8587
c0065db7 8588"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8589documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8590
c0065db7
RM
8591The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8592occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8593One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8594below.
8595
8596@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8597For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8598object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8599offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8600field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8601in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8602without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8603The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8604references.
8605
c0065db7
RM
8606The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8607be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8608themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8609runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8610compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8611support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8612run without error on an older system.
8613
c0065db7
RM
8614@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8615enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8616
8617@cindex direct linking to a dll
8618@item direct linking to a dll
8619The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8620including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8621libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8622traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8623libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8624function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8625though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8626storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8627tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8628large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8629
c0065db7 8630Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8631@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8632of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8633perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8634select the dll instead of an import library.
8635
2ca22b03 8636
69da35b5
NC
8637For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8638to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8639
8640@example
45e948fe
NC
8641libxxx.dll.a
8642xxx.dll.a
8643libxxx.a
8644xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8645libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8646cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8647libxxx.dll
8648xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8649@end example
8650
69da35b5
NC
8651before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8652
c0065db7
RM
8653(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8654where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8655@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8656file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8657@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8658
c0065db7
RM
8659Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8660@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8661was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8662various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8663could coexist on the same machine.
8664
2ca22b03
NC
8665The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8666applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8667libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8668
8669@example
8670bin/
8671 cygxxx.dll
8672lib/
8673 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8674 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8675@end example
8676
c0065db7
RM
8677Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8678done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8679
86801. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8681@example
8682gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8683@end example
2ca22b03 8684
69da35b5
NC
8685However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8686(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8687@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8688not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8689
2ca22b03
NC
86902. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8691directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8692should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8693making the app/dll.
8694
8695@example
8696ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8697@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8698
8699Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8700
8701@example
8702gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8703@end example
69da35b5
NC
8704
8705This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8706perfectly legal
8707
8708@example
8709bin/
8710 cygxxx-5.dll
8711lib/
c0065db7 8712 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8713@end example
8714
dc8465bf 8715Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8716even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8717@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8718
8719Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8720wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8721
87221. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8723work with auto-imported data.
8724
dc8465bf
NC
87252. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8726import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8727symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8728for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8729possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8730
45e948fe
NC
87313. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8732critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8733in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8734stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8735
69da35b5 8736So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8737true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8738a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8739binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8740massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8741requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8742will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8743
c0065db7 8744@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8745@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8746@item adding additional names
8747Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8748A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8749exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8750when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8751import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8752
c0065db7 8753@example
dc8465bf
NC
8754LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8755
8756EXPORTS
c0065db7 8757foo
dc8465bf 8758_foo = foo
c0065db7 8759@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8760
8761The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8762
8763Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8764source code using the "weak" attribute:
8765
c0065db7
RM
8766@example
8767void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8768void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8769@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8770
8771See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8772symbols.
8773
8774@item renaming symbols
8775Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8776kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8777@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8778DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8779created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8780
c0065db7 8781@example
dc8465bf
NC
8782LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8783
8784EXPORTS
8785_foo = foo
c0065db7 8786@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8787
8788The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8789@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8790@end table
dc8465bf 8791
0a5d968e 8792Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8793unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8794If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8795@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8796that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8797@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8798renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8799to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8800the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8801In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8802which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8803
8804@cindex weak externals
8805@item weak externals
8806The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8807weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8808defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8809are three variants of weak externals:
8810@itemize
8811@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8812called lazy externals.
8813@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8814This form is not presently implemented.
8815@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8816implemented.
8817@end itemize
8818As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8819are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8820uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8821
8822@cindex aligned common symbols
8823@item aligned common symbols
8824As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8825desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8826the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8827carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8828by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8829tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8830but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8831warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8832
2ca22b03
NC
8833@end table
8834
8835@ifclear GENERIC
8836@lowersections
8837@end ifclear
8838@end ifset
8839
e0001a05
NC
8840@ifset XTENSA
8841@ifclear GENERIC
8842@raisesections
8843@end ifclear
8844
8845@node Xtensa
8846@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8847
8848@cindex Xtensa processors
8849The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8850@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8851specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8852keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8853example, with the command:
8854
8855@smallexample
8856SECTIONS
8857@{
8858 .text : @{
8859 *(.literal .text)
8860 @}
8861@}
8862@end smallexample
8863
8864@noindent
8865@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8866and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8867literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8868interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8869group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8870files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8871and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8872
43cd72b9 8873@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8874@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8875Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8876provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8877is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8878literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8879will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8880location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8881the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8882unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8883@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8884range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8885
8886For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8887to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8888instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8889instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8890instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8891@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8892hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8893By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8894switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8895density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8896instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8897performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8898linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8899a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8900
8901The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8902control the linker:
8903
8904@cindex Xtensa options
8905@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8906@item --size-opt
8907When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8908more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8909no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8910alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8911preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8912
8913@item --abi-windowed
8914@itemx --abi-call0
8915Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8916PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8917because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8918conventions.
8919Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8920of the first input object.
8921A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8922or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8923@end table
e0001a05
NC
8924
8925@ifclear GENERIC
8926@lowersections
8927@end ifclear
8928@end ifset
8929
252b5132
RH
8930@ifclear SingleFormat
8931@node BFD
8932@chapter BFD
8933
8934@cindex back end
8935@cindex object file management
8936@cindex object formats available
8937@kindex objdump -i
8938The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8939These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8940object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8941format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8942it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8943associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8944object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8945(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8946list all the formats available for your configuration.
8947
8948@cindex BFD requirements
8949@cindex requirements for BFD
8950As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8951several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8952BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8953formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8954been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8955BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8956may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8957
8958One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8959mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8960useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8961conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8962
8963@menu
8964* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8965@end menu
8966
8967@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8968@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8969@cindex opening object files
8970@include bfdsumm.texi
8971@end ifclear
8972
8973@node Reporting Bugs
8974@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8975@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8976@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8977
ff5dcc92 8978Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8979
8980Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8981it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8982to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8983work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8984@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8985
8986In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8987information that enables us to fix the bug.
8988
8989@menu
8990* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8991* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8992@end menu
8993
8994@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8995@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8996@cindex bug criteria
8997
8998If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8999
9000@itemize @bullet
9001@cindex fatal signal
9002@cindex linker crash
9003@cindex crash of linker
9004@item
9005If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9006@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9007
9008@cindex error on valid input
9009@item
ff5dcc92 9010If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9011
9012@cindex invalid input
9013@item
ff5dcc92 9014If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9015may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9016object files are correct.
9017
9018@item
9019If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9020improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9021@end itemize
9022
9023@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9024@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9025@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9026@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9027
9028A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9029products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9030recommend you contact that organization first.
9031
9032You can find contact information for many support companies and
9033individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9034distribution.
9035
ad22bfe8 9036@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9037Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9038@value{BUGURL}.
9039@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9040
9041The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9042@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9043fact or leave it out, state it!
9044
9045Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9046problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9047assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9048matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9049the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9050location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9051were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9052into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9053specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9054and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9055
9056Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9057the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9058on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9059
9060Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9061bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9062respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9063You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9064
9065To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9066
9067@itemize @bullet
9068@item
ff5dcc92 9069The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9070the @samp{--version} argument.
9071
9072Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9073the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9074
9075@item
ff5dcc92 9076Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9077patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9078
9079@item
9080The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9081version number.
9082
9083@item
ff5dcc92 9084What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9085``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9086
9087@item
9088The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9089observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9090list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9091sufficient.
9092
9093If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9094and then we might not encounter the bug.
9095
9096@item
9097A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9098bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9099provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9100bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9101state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9102requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9103we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9104attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9105
9106If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9107@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9108object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9109@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9110how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9111
9112@item
9113A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9114incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9115
ff5dcc92 9116Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9117will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9118not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9119a chance to make a mistake.
9120
9121Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9122say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9123copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9124C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9125and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9126fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9127you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9128any conclusion from our observations.
9129
9130@item
ff5dcc92 9131If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9132diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9133@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9134If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9135context, not by line number.
9136
9137The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9138sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9139@end itemize
9140
9141Here are some things that are not necessary:
9142
9143@itemize @bullet
9144@item
9145A description of the envelope of the bug.
9146
9147Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9148which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9149changes will not affect it.
9150
9151This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9152will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9153with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9154We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9155
9156Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9157of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9158output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9159less time, and so on.
9160
9161However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9162report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9163
9164@item
9165A patch for the bug.
9166
9167A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9168the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9169a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9170to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9171
ff5dcc92 9172Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9173construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9174through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9175able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9176fixed.
9177
9178And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9179patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9180help us to understand.
9181
9182@item
9183A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9184
9185Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9186things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9187@end itemize
9188
9189@node MRI
9190@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9191@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9192To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9193linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9194alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9195described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9196simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9197@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9198linker commands; these commands are described here.
9199
9200In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9201file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9202features to make use of them.
9203
9204You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9205@samp{-c} command-line option.
9206
9207Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9208command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9209blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9210MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9211issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9212
9213Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9214
9215You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9216lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9217The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9218
9219@table @code
9220@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9221@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9222@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9223Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9224the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9225@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9226your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9227script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9228commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9229input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9230@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9231
9232@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9233@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9234Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9235in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9236
9237@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9238
9239@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9240@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9241Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9242@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9243
9244@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9245@item BASE @var{expression}
9246Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9247absolute addresses) in the output file.
9248
9249@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9250@item CHIP @var{expression}
9251@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9252This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9253
9254@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9255@item END
9256This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9257
9258@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9259@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9260Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9261language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9262
9263@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9264@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9265Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9266@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9267
9268The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9269same line, with no change in its effect.
9270
9271@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9272@item LOAD @var{filename}
9273@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9274Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9275same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9276command line.
9277
9278@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9279@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9280@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9281MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9282option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9283
9284@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9285@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9286@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9287Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9288order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9289script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9290sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9291file, in the order specified.
9292
9293@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9294@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9295@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9296@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9297Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9298@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9299
9300@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9301@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9302@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9303@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9304You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9305specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9306If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9307@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9308@end table
9309
793c5807
NC
9310@node GNU Free Documentation License
9311@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9312@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9313
370b66a1
CD
9314@node LD Index
9315@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9316
9317@printindex cp
9318
9319@tex
7ca01ed9 9320% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9321% meantime:
9322\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9323\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9324\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9325\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9326\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9327\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9328\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9329\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9330\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9331% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9332@end tex
9333
252b5132 9334@bye